diff options
author | mattkae <mattkae@protonmail.com> | 2022-06-07 08:23:47 -0400 |
---|---|---|
committer | mattkae <mattkae@protonmail.com> | 2022-06-07 08:23:47 -0400 |
commit | bd18a38c2898548a3664a9ddab9f79c84f2caf4a (patch) | |
tree | 95b9933376770381bd8859782ae763be81c2d72b /elpa/auctex-13.1.3/auctex.info | |
parent | b07628dddf418d4f47b858e6c35fd3520fbaeed2 (diff) | |
parent | ef160dea332af4b4fe5e2717b962936c67e5fe9e (diff) |
Merge conflict
Diffstat (limited to 'elpa/auctex-13.1.3/auctex.info')
-rw-r--r-- | elpa/auctex-13.1.3/auctex.info | 9633 |
1 files changed, 0 insertions, 9633 deletions
diff --git a/elpa/auctex-13.1.3/auctex.info b/elpa/auctex-13.1.3/auctex.info deleted file mode 100644 index b9ac9ee..0000000 --- a/elpa/auctex-13.1.3/auctex.info +++ /dev/null @@ -1,9633 +0,0 @@ -This is auctex.info, produced by makeinfo version 6.8 from auctex.texi. - -This manual is for AUCTeX (version 13.1.3 from 2022-04-16), a -sophisticated TeX environment for Emacs. - - Copyright (C) 1992-1995, 2001, 2002, 2004-2022 Free Software -Foundation, Inc. - - Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this - document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, - Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software - Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts and no - Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section - entitled "GNU Free Documentation License." -INFO-DIR-SECTION Emacs -START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY -* AUCTeX: (auctex). A sophisticated TeX environment for Emacs. -END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY - -INFO-DIR-SECTION TeX -START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY -* AUCTeX: (auctex). A sophisticated TeX environment for Emacs. -END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Top, Next: Copying, Up: (dir) - -AUCTeX -****** - -This manual may be copied under the conditions spelled out in *note -Copying this Manual::. - - AUCTeX is an integrated environment for editing LaTeX, ConTeXt, -docTeX, Texinfo, and TeX files. - - Although AUCTeX contains a large number of features, there are no -reasons to despair. You can continue to write TeX and LaTeX documents -the way you are used to, and only start using the multiple features in -small steps. AUCTeX is not monolithic, each feature described in this -manual is useful by itself, but together they provide an environment -where you will make very few LaTeX errors, and makes it easy to find the -errors that may slip through anyway. - - It is a good idea to make a printout of AUCTeX's reference card -'tex-ref.tex' or one of its typeset versions. - - If you want to make AUCTeX aware of style files and multifile -documents right away, insert the following in your init file (usually -'~/.emacs.d/init.el'). - - (setq TeX-auto-save t) - (setq TeX-parse-self t) - (setq-default TeX-master nil) - - Another thing you should enable is RefTeX, a comprehensive solution -for managing cross references, bibliographies, indices, document -navigation and a few other things. (*Note (reftex)Installation::.) - - For detailed information about the preview-latex subsystem of AUCTeX, -see *note Introduction: (preview-latex)Top. - - There is a mailing list for general discussion about AUCTeX: write a -mail with "subscribe" in the subject to <auctex-request@gnu.org> to join -it. Send contributions to <auctex@gnu.org>. - - Bug reports should go to <bug-auctex@gnu.org>, suggestions for new -features, and pleas for help should go to either <auctex-devel@gnu.org> -(the AUCTeX developers), or to <auctex@gnu.org> if they might have -general interest. Please use the command 'M-x TeX-submit-bug-report -<RET>' to report bugs if possible. You can subscribe to a low-volume -announcement list by sending "subscribe" in the subject of a mail to -<info-auctex-request@gnu.org>. - -* Menu: - -* Copying:: Copying -* Introduction:: Introduction to AUCTeX -* Editing:: Editing the Document Source -* Display:: Controlling Screen Display -* Processing:: Starting Processors, Viewers and Other Programs -* Customization:: Customization and Extension -* Appendices:: Copying, Changes, Development, FAQ, Texinfo mode -* Indices:: Indices - - -- The Detailed Node Listing -- - -Introduction - -* Summary:: Overview of AUCTeX -* Installation:: Installing AUCTeX -* Quick Start:: Quick Start - -Editing the Document Source - -* Quotes:: Inserting double quotes -* Font Specifiers:: Inserting Font Specifiers -* Sectioning:: Inserting chapters, sections, etc. -* Environments:: Inserting Environment Templates -* Mathematics:: Entering Mathematics -* Completion:: Completion of macros -* Commenting:: Commenting text -* Indenting:: Reflecting syntactic constructs with whitespace -* Filling:: Automatic and manual line breaking - -Inserting Environment Templates - -* Equations:: Equations -* Floats:: Floats -* Itemize-like:: Itemize-like Environments -* Tabular-like:: Tabular-like Environments -* Customizing Environments:: Customizing Environments - -Controlling Screen Display - -* Font Locking:: Font Locking -* Folding:: Folding Macros and Environments -* Outline:: Outlining the Document -* Narrowing:: Restricting display and editing to a portion of the buffer -* Prettifying:: Displaying Greek and math macros as Unicode characters - -Font Locking - -* Fontification of macros:: Fontification of macros -* Fontification of quotes:: Fontification of quotes -* Fontification of math:: Fontification of math constructs -* Verbatim content:: Verbatim macros and environments -* Faces:: Faces used by font-latex -* Known problems:: Known fontification problems - -Starting Processors, Viewers and Other Programs - -* Commands:: Invoking external commands. -* Viewing:: Invoking external viewers. -* Debugging:: Debugging TeX and LaTeX output. -* Checking:: Checking the document. -* Control:: Controlling the processes. -* Cleaning:: Cleaning intermediate and output files. -* Documentation:: Documentation about macros and packages. - -Viewing the Formatted Output - -* Starting Viewers:: Starting viewers -* I/O Correlation:: Forward and inverse search - -Catching the errors - -* Ignoring warnings:: Controlling warnings to be reported -* Error overview:: List of all errors and warnings - -Customization and Extension - -* Multifile:: Multifile Documents -* Parsing Files:: Automatic Parsing of TeX Files -* Internationalization:: Language Support -* Automatic:: Automatic Customization -* Style Files:: Writing Your Own Style Support - -Language Support - -* European:: Using AUCTeX with European Languages -* Japanese:: Using AUCTeX with Japanese - -Automatic Customization - -* Automatic Global:: Automatic Customization for the Site -* Automatic Private:: Automatic Customization for a User -* Automatic Local:: Automatic Customization for a Directory - -Writing Your Own Style Support - -* Simple Style:: A Simple Style File -* Adding Macros:: Adding Support for Macros -* Adding Environments:: Adding Support for Environments -* Adding Other:: Adding or Examining Other Information -* Hacking the Parser:: Automatic Extraction of New Things - -Copying, Changes, Development, FAQ - -* Copying this Manual:: -* Changes:: -* Development:: -* FAQ:: -* Texinfo mode:: - -Copying this Manual - -* GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual. - -Indices - -* Key Index:: -* Function Index:: -* Variable Index:: -* Concept Index:: - - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Copying, Next: Introduction, Prev: Top, Up: Top - -Copying -******* - -AUCTeX primarily consists of Lisp files for Emacs, but there are also -installation scripts and files and TeX support files. All of those are -"free"; this means that everyone is free to use them and free to -redistribute them on a free basis. The files of AUCTeX are not in the -public domain; they are copyrighted and there are restrictions on their -distribution, but these restrictions are designed to permit everything -that a good cooperating citizen would want to do. What is not allowed -is to try to prevent others from further sharing any version of these -programs that they might get from you. - - Specifically, we want to make sure that you have the right to give -away copies of the files that constitute AUCTeX, that you receive source -code or else can get it if you want it, that you can change these files -or use pieces of them in new free programs, and that you know you can do -these things. - - To make sure that everyone has such rights, we have to forbid you to -deprive anyone else of these rights. For example, if you distribute -copies of parts of AUCTeX, you must give the recipients all the rights -that you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get -the source code. And you must tell them their rights. - - Also, for our own protection, we must make certain that everyone -finds out that there is no warranty for AUCTeX. If any parts are -modified by someone else and passed on, we want their recipients to know -that what they have is not what we distributed, so that any problems -introduced by others will not reflect on our reputation. - - The precise conditions of the licenses for the files currently being -distributed as part of AUCTeX are found in the General Public Licenses -that accompany them. This manual specifically is covered by the GNU -Free Documentation License (*note Copying this Manual::). - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Introduction, Next: Editing, Prev: Copying, Up: Top - -1 Introduction -************** - -* Menu: - -* Summary:: Overview of AUCTeX -* Installation:: Installing AUCTeX -* Quick Start:: Quick Start - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Summary, Next: Installation, Up: Introduction - -1.1 Overview of AUCTeX -====================== - -AUCTeX is a comprehensive customizable integrated environment for -writing input files for TeX, LaTeX, ConTeXt, Texinfo, and docTeX using -Emacs. - - It supports you in the insertion of macros, environments, and -sectioning commands by providing completion alternatives and prompting -for parameters. It automatically indents your text as you type it and -lets you format a whole file at once. The outlining and folding -facilities provide you with a focused and clean view of your text. - - AUCTeX lets you process your source files by running TeX and related -tools (such as output filters, post processors for generating indices -and bibliographies, and viewers) from inside Emacs. AUCTeX lets you -browse through the errors TeX reported, while it moves the cursor -directly to the reported error, and displays some documentation for that -particular error. This will even work when the document is spread over -several files. - - One component of AUCTeX that LaTeX users will find attractive is -preview-latex, a combination of folding and in-source previewing that -provides true "What You See Is What You Get" experience in your -sourcebuffer, while letting you retain full control. - - More detailed information about the features and usage of AUCTeX can -be found in the remainder of this manual. - - AUCTeX is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, and hence you can easily -add new features for your own needs. It is a GNU project and -distributed under the 'GNU General Public License Version 3'. - - The most recent version is always available at -<https://ftp.gnu.org/pub/gnu/auctex/>. - - WWW users may want to check out the AUCTeX page at -<https://www.gnu.org/software/auctex/>. - - For comprehensive information about how to install AUCTeX *Note -Installation::, or *note Installation under MS Windows::, respectively. - - If you are considering upgrading AUCTeX, the recent changes are -described in *note Changes::. - - If you want to discuss AUCTeX with other users or its developers, -there are several mailing lists you can use. - - Send a mail with the subject "subscribe" to <auctex-request@gnu.org> -in order to join the general discussion list for AUCTeX. Articles -should be sent to <auctex@gnu.org>. In a similar way, you can subscribe -to the <info-auctex@gnu.org> list for just getting important -announcements about AUCTeX. The list <bug-auctex@gnu.org> is for bug -reports which you should usually file with the 'M-x -TeX-submit-bug-report <RET>' command. If you want to address the -developers of AUCTeX themselves with technical issues, they can be found -on the discussion list <auctex-devel@gnu.org>. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Installation, Next: Quick Start, Prev: Summary, Up: Introduction - -1.2 Installing AUCTeX -===================== - -The modern and strongly recommended way of installing AUCTeX is by using -the Emacs package manager integrated in Emacs 24 and greater (ELPA). -Simply do 'M-x list-packages <RET>', mark the auctex package for -installation with 'i', and hit 'x' to execute the installation -procedure. That's all. - - 'use-package' users can use this simple recipe in their -'user-init-file' which essentially does the same as the manual -installation explained above. - - (use-package tex - :ensure auctex) - - Using the ELPA version has several advantages. Besides being -platform and OS independent, you will receive intermediate bugfix -releases between major AUCTeX releases conveniently. For past ELPA -releases, see <https://elpa.gnu.org/packages/auctex.html>. Once the -installation is completed, you can skip the rest of this section and -proceed to *note Quick Start::. - - The remainder of this section is about installing AUCTeX from a -release tarball or from a checkout of the AUCTeX repository. - - Installing AUCTeX should be simple: merely './configure', 'make', and -'make install' for a standard site-wide installation (most other -installations can be done by specifying a '--prefix=...' option). - - On many systems, this will already activate the package, making its -modes the default instead of the built-in modes of Emacs. If this is -not the case, consult *note Loading the package::. Please read through -this document fully before installing anything. The installation -procedure has changed as compared to earlier versions. Users of -MS Windows are asked to consult *Note Installation under MS Windows::. - -* Menu: - -* Prerequisites:: -* Configure:: -* Build/install and uninstall:: -* Loading the package:: -* Advice for package providers:: -* Advice for non-privileged users:: -* Installation under MS Windows:: -* Customizing:: - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Prerequisites, Next: Configure, Up: Installation - -1.2.1 Prerequisites -------------------- - - * GNU Emacs 25.1 or higher - - Using preview-latex requires a version of Emacs compiled with image - support. - - Windows - Precompiled versions are available from - <https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/emacs/windows/>. - macOS - For an overview of precompiled versions of Emacs for macOS see - for example <https://www.emacswiki.org/emacs/EmacsForMacOS>. - GNU/Linux - Most GNU/Linux distributions nowadays provide a recent variant - of Emacs via their package repositories. - Self-compiled - Compiling Emacs yourself requires a C compiler and a number of - tools and development libraries. Details are beyond the scope - of this manual. Instructions for checking out the source code - can be found at <https://savannah.gnu.org/git/?group=emacs>. - - * A working TeX installation - - Well, AUCTeX would be pointless without that. Processing - documentation requires TeX, LaTeX and Texinfo during installation. - preview-latex requires Dvips or 'dvipng' for its operation in DVI - mode. The default configuration of AUCTeX is tailored for - TeX Live-based distributions, but can be adapted easily. - - * A recent Ghostscript - - This is needed for operation of preview-latex in both DVI and PDF - mode. Ghostscript version 7.07 or newer is required. - - * GNU make - - Recent AUCTeX uses GNU make specific capabilities in the Makefiles. - If your OS's default 'make' command is not GNU make, you have to - obtain it in order to build AUCTeX by yourself. GNU make is - sometimes provided under the name 'gmake' in your OS's binary - package system. - - * The Texinfo package - - Strictly speaking, you can get away without it if you are building - from the distribution tarball, have not modified any files and - don't need a printed version of the manual: the pregenerated info - file is included in the tarball. At least version 4.0 is required. - - For some known issues with various software, see *note -(preview-latex)Known problems::. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Configure, Next: Build/install and uninstall, Prev: Prerequisites, Up: Installation - -1.2.2 Configure ---------------- - -The first step is to configure the source code, telling it where various -files will be. To do so, run - - ./configure OPTIONS - - (Note: if you have fetched AUCTeX from Git rather than a regular -release, you will have to first follow the instructions in -'README.GIT'). - - On many machines, you will not need to specify any options, but if -'configure' cannot determine something on its own, you'll need to help -it out with one of these options: - -'--prefix=PREFIX' - All automatic placements for package components will be chosen from - sensible existing hierarchies below this: directories like 'man', - 'share' and 'bin' are supposed to be directly below PREFIX. - - Only if no workable placement can be found there, in some cases an - alternative search will be made in a prefix deduced from a suitable - binary. - - '/usr/local' is the default PREFIX, intended to be suitable for a - site-wide installation. If you are packaging this as an operating - system component for distribution, the setting '/usr' will probably - be the right choice. See *note Advice for package providers:: for - detail. - - If you are planning to install the package as a single - non-priviledged user, you will typically set PREFIX to your home - directory. Consult *note Advice for non-privileged users:: for - addtional instructions. - -'--with-emacs=/PATH/TO/EMACS' - If you are using a pretest which isn't in your 'PATH', or - 'configure' is not finding the right Emacs executable, you can - specify it with this option. - -'--with-lispdir=LISPDIR' - This option specifies the location of the 'site-lisp' directory - within 'load-path' under which the files will get installed (the - bulk will get installed in a subdirectory). './configure' should - figure this out by itself. - -'--with-auctexstartfile=auctex.el' -'--with-previewstartfile=preview-latex.el' - This is the name of the respective startup files. If LISPDIR - contains a subdirectory 'site-start.d', the start files are placed - there, and 'site-start.el' should load them automatically. Please - be aware that you must not move the start files after installation - since other files are found _relative_ to them. - -'--with-packagelispdir=auctex' - This is the directory where the bulk of the package gets located. - The startfile adds this into 'load-path'. - -'--with-auto-dir=/DIR' - You can use this option to specify the directory containing - automatically generated information by 'M-x - TeX-auto-generate-global <RET>'. It is not necessary for most TeX - installs, but may be used if you don't like the directory that - configure is suggesting. - -'--help' - This is not an option specific to AUCTeX. A number of standard - options to 'configure' exist, and we do not have the room to - describe them here; a short description of each is available, using - '--help'. - -'--disable-preview' - This disables configuration and installation of preview-latex. - This option is not actually recommended. If your Emacs does not - support images, you should really upgrade to a newer version. - Distributors should, if possible, refrain from distributing AUCTeX - and preview-latex separately in order to avoid confusion and - upgrade hassles if users install partial packages on their own. - -'--with-texmf-dir=/DIR' -'--without-texmf-dir' - This option is used for specifying a TDS-compliant directory - hierarchy. Using '--with-texmf-dir=/DIR' you can specify where the - TeX TDS directory hierarchy resides, and the TeX files will get - installed in '/DIR/tex/latex/preview/'. - - If you use the '--without-texmf-dir' option, the TeX-related files - will be kept in the Emacs Lisp tree, and at runtime the 'TEXINPUTS' - environment variable will be made to point there. You can install - those files into your own TeX tree at some later time with 'M-x - preview-install-styles <RET>'. - -'--with-tex-dir=/DIR' - If you want to specify an exact directory for the preview TeX - files, use '--with-tex-dir=/DIR'. In this case, the files will be - placed in '/DIR', and you'll also need the following option: - -'--with-doc-dir=/DIR' - This option may be used to specify where the TeX documentation - goes. It is to be used when you are using '--with-tex-dir=/DIR', - but is normally not necessary otherwise. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Build/install and uninstall, Next: Loading the package, Prev: Configure, Up: Installation - -1.2.3 Build/install and uninstall ---------------------------------- - -Once 'configure' has been run, simply enter - - make - -at the prompt to byte-compile the lisp files, extract the TeX files and -build the documentation files. To install the files into the locations -chosen earlier, type - - make install - -You may need special privileges to install, e.g., if you are installing -into system directories. - - Should you want to completely remove the installed package, in the -same directory you built AUCTeX run - - make uninstall - -You will need administration privileges if you installed the package -into system directories. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Loading the package, Next: Advice for package providers, Prev: Build/install and uninstall, Up: Installation - -1.2.4 Loading the package -------------------------- - -You can detect the successful activation of AUCTeX and preview-latex in -the menus after loading a LaTeX file like 'circ.tex': AUCTeX then gives -you a 'Command' menu, and preview-latex gives you a 'Preview' menu. - - With Emacs (or if you explicitly disabled use of the package system), -the startup files 'auctex.el' and 'preview-latex.el' may already be in a -directory of the 'site-start.d/' variety if your Emacs installation -provides it. In that case they should be automatically loaded on -startup and nothing else needs to be done. If not, they should at least -have been placed somewhere in your 'load-path'. You can then load them -by placing the lines - - (load "auctex.el" nil t t) - (load "preview-latex.el" nil t t) -into your init file such as 'init.el' or '.emacs'. - - If you explicitly used '--with-lispdir', you may need to add the -specified directory into Emacs' 'load-path' variable by adding something -like - - (add-to-list 'load-path "~/elisp") -before the above lines into your Emacs startup file. - - For site-wide activation in GNU Emacs, see *Note Advice for package -providers::. - - Once activated, the modes provided by AUCTeX are used per default for -all supported file types. If you want to change the modes for which it -is operative instead of the default, use - M-x customize-option <RET> TeX-modes <RET> - - If you want to remove a preinstalled AUCTeX completely before any of -its modes have been used, - (unload-feature 'tex-site) -should accomplish that. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Advice for package providers, Next: Advice for non-privileged users, Prev: Loading the package, Up: Installation - -1.2.5 Providing AUCTeX as a package ------------------------------------ - -As a package provider, you should make sure that your users will be -served best according to their intentions, and keep in mind that a -system might be used by more than one user, with different preferences. - - There are people that prefer the built-in Emacs modes for editing TeX -files, in particular plain TeX users. There are various ways to tell -AUCTeX even after auto-activation that it should not get used, and they -are described in *note Introduction to AUCTeX: Introduction. - - So if you have users that don't want to use the preinstalled AUCTeX, -they can easily get rid of it. Activating AUCTeX by default is -therefore a good choice. - - If the installation procedure did not achieve this already by placing -'auctex.el' and 'preview-latex.el' into a possibly existing -'site-start.d' directory, you can do this by placing - - (load "auctex.el" nil t t) - (load "preview-latex.el" nil t t) - -in the system-wide 'site-start.el'. - - The '--without-texmf-dir' option can be convenient for systems that -are intended to support more than a single TeX distribution. Since more -often than not TeX packages for operating system distributions are -either much more outdated or much less complete than separately provided -systems like TeX Live, this method may be generally preferable when -providing packages. - - The following package structure would be adequate for a typical fully -supported Unix-like installation: - -'preview-tetex' - Style files and documentation for 'preview.sty', placed into a TeX - tree where it is accessible from the teTeX executables usually - delivered with a system. If there are other commonly used TeX - system packages, it might be appropriate to provide separate - packages for those. -'auctex-emacs-tetex' - This package will require the installation of 'preview-tetex' and - will record in 'TeX-macro-global' where to find the TeX tree. It - is also a good idea to run - emacs -batch -f TeX-auto-generate-global - when either AUCTeX or teTeX get installed or upgraded. If your - users might want to work with a different TeX distribution - (nowadays pretty common), instead consider the following: -'auctex-emacs' - This package will be compiled with '--without-texmf-dir' and will - consequently contain the 'preview' style files in its private - directory. It will probably not be possible to initialize - 'TeX-macro-global' to a sensible value, so running - 'TeX-auto-generate-global' does not appear useful. This package - would neither conflict with nor provide 'preview-tetex'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Advice for non-privileged users, Next: Installation under MS Windows, Prev: Advice for package providers, Up: Installation - -1.2.6 Installation for non-privileged users -------------------------------------------- - -Often people without system administration privileges want to install -software for their private use. In that case you need to pass more -options to the 'configure' script. - - The main expedient is using the '--prefix' option to the 'configure' -script, and let it point to the personal home directory. In that way, -resulting binaries will be installed under the 'bin' subdirectory of -your home directory, manual pages under 'man' and so on. It is -reasonably easy to maintain a bunch of personal software, since the -prefix argument is supported by most 'configure' scripts. - - You often need to specify '--with-lispdir' option as well. If you -haven't installed Emacs under your home directory and use Emacs -installed in system directories, the 'configure' script might not be -able to figure out suitable place to install lisp files under your home -directory. In that case, the 'configure' script would silently choose, -by default, the 'site-lisp' directory within 'load-path' for the place, -where administration privileges are usually required to put relevant -files. Thus you will have to tell the 'configure' script explicitly -where to put those files by, e.g., -'--with-lispdir='/home/myself/share/emacs/site-lisp''. - - You'll have to add something like -'/home/myself/share/emacs/site-lisp' to your 'load-path' variable, if it -isn't there already. - - In addition, you will have to tell 'configure' script where to -install TeX-related files such as 'preview.sty' if preview-latex isn't -disabled. It is enough to specify '--with-texmf-dir=$HOME/texmf' for -most typical cases, but you have to create the direcotry '$HOME/texmf' -in advance if it doesn't exist. If this prescription doesn't work, -consider using one or more of the options '--with-texmf-dir=/DIR', -'--without-texmf-dir', '--with-tex-dir=/DIR' and '--with-doc-dir=/DIR'. -See *note Configure:: for detail of these options. - - Now here is another thing to ponder: perhaps you want to make it easy -for other users to share parts of your personal Emacs configuration. In -general, you can do this by writing '~myself/' anywhere where you -specify paths to something installed in your personal subdirectories, -not merely '~/', since the latter, when used by other users, will point -to non-existent files. - - For yourself, it will do to manipulate environment variables in your -'.profile' resp. '.login' files. But if people will be copying just -Elisp files, their copies will not work. While it would in general be -preferable if the added components where available from a shell level, -too (like when you call the standalone info reader, or try using -'preview.sty' for functionality besides of Emacs previews), it will be a -big help already if things work from inside of Emacs. - - Here is how to do the various parts: - -Making the Elisp available -.......................... - -In GNU Emacs, it should be sufficient if people just do - - (load "~myself/share/emacs/site-lisp/auctex.el" nil t t) - (load "~myself/share/emacs/site-lisp/preview-latex.el" nil t t) -where the path points to your personal installation. The rest of the -package should be found relative from there without further ado. - -Making the Info files available -............................... - -For making the info files accessible from within Elisp, something like -the following might be convenient to add into your or other people's -startup files: - - (eval-after-load 'info - '(add-to-list 'Info-directory-list "~myself/info")) - -Making the LaTeX style available -................................ - -If you want others to be able to share your installation, you should -configure it using '--without-texmf-dir', in which case things should -work as well for them as for you. - -1.2.6.1 Using AUCTeX from local Git repo -........................................ - -With the techniques described above, it is also possible to use AUCTeX -directly from a local Git repository. Let's assume you have your Git -repositories under '~/development/'. - - First, you have to fetch a copy of the AUCTeX Git repository. In a -shell, change directory to '~/development/' and do: - git clone https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/auctex.git - - Now change directory to '~/development/auctex' and run -'./autogen.sh'. Next thing is to run 'configure' like this: - ./configure --without-texmf-dir --with-lispdir=. - -When finished, simply enter - make -and you're finished. Note that the 'make install' step is not -necessary. - - Now you have to tell Emacs about the plan. The following variables -must be set in your init file because their normal values are only -correct when AUCTeX is installed: - (setq TeX-data-directory "~/development/auctex" - TeX-lisp-directory TeX-data-directory) - -The info files will be available with this: - (eval-after-load 'info - '(add-to-list 'Info-additional-directory-list - "~/development/auctex/doc")) - -Now you're ready to load 'auctex.el' and 'preview-latex.el' out of this -directory: - (load "~/development/auctex/auctex.el" nil t t) - (load "~/development/auctex/preview-latex.el" nil t t) - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Installation under MS Windows, Next: Customizing, Prev: Advice for non-privileged users, Up: Installation - -1.2.7 Installation under MS Windows ------------------------------------ - -In a Nutshell -............. - -The following are brief installation instructions for the impatient. In -case you don't understand some of this, run into trouble of some sort, -or need more elaborate information, refer to the detailed instructions -further below. - - 1. Install the prerequisites, i.e. GNU Emacs, MSYS or Cygwin, a TeX - system, and Ghostscript. - - 2. Open the MSYS shell or a Cygwin shell and change to the directory - containing the unzipped file contents. - - 3. Configure AUCTeX: - - For Emacs: Many people like to install AUCTeX into the pseudo file - system hierarchy set up by the Emacs installation. Assuming Emacs - is installed in 'C:/Program Files/Emacs' and the directory for - local additions of your TeX system, e.g. MiKTeX, is - 'C:/localtexmf', you can do this by typing the following statement - at the shell prompt: - - ./configure --prefix='C:/Program Files/Emacs' \ - --infodir='C:/Program Files/Emacs/info' \ - --with-texmf-dir='C:/localtexmf' - - The commands above is example for common usage. More on - configuration options can be found in the detailed installation - instructions below. - - If the configuration script failed to find all required programs, - make sure that these programs are in your system path and add - directories containing the programs to the 'PATH' environment - variable if necessary. Here is how to do that in W2000/XP: - - 1. On the desktop, right click "My Computer" and select - properties. - 2. Click on "Advanced" in the "System Properties" window. - 3. Select "Environment Variables". - 4. Select "path" in "System Variables" and click "edit". Move to - the front in the line (this might require scrolling) and add - the missing path including drive letter, ended with a - semicolon. - - 4. If there were no further error messages, type - - make - - In case there were, please refer to the detailed description below. - - 5. Finish the installation by typing - - make install - -Detailed Installation Instructions -.................................. - -Installation of AUCTeX under Windows is in itself not more complicated -than on other platforms. However, meeting the prerequisites might -require more work than on some other platforms, and feel less natural. - - If you are experiencing any problems, even if you think they are of -your own making, be sure to report them to <auctex-devel@gnu.org> so -that we can explain things better in future. - - Windows is a problematic platform for installation scripts. The main -problem is that the installation procedure requires consistent file -names in order to find its way in the directory hierarchy, and Windows -path names are a mess. - - The installation procedure tries finding stuff in system search paths -and in Emacs paths. For that to succeed, you have to use the same -syntax and spelling and case of paths everywhere: in your system search -paths, in Emacs' 'load-path' variable, as argument to the scripts. If -your path names contain spaces or other 'shell-unfriendly' characters, -most notably backslashes for directory separators, place the whole path -in '"double quote marks"' whenever you specify it on a command line. - - Avoid 'helpful' magic file names like '/cygdrive/c' and -'C:\PROGRA~1\' like the plague. It is quite unlikely that the scripts -will be able to identify the actual file names involved. Use the full -paths, making use of normal Windows drive letters like ' 'C:/Program -Files/Emacs' ' where required, and using the same combination of upper- -and lowercase letters as in the actual files. File names containing -shell-special characters like spaces or backslashes (if you prefer that -syntax) need to get properly quoted to the shell: the above example used -single quotes for that. - - Ok, now here are the steps to perform: - - 1. You need to unpack the AUCTeX distribution (which you seemingly - have done since you are reading this). It must be unpacked in a - separate installation directory outside of your Emacs file - hierarchy: the installation will later copy all necessary files to - their final destination, and you can ultimately remove the - directory where you unpacked the files. - - Line endings are a problem under Windows. The distribution - contains only text files, and theoretically most of the involved - tools should get along with that. However, the files are processed - by various utilities, and it is conceivable that not all of them - will use the same line ending conventions. If you encounter - problems, it might help if you try unpacking (or checking out) the - files in binary mode, if your tools allow that. - - If you don't have a suitable unpacking tool, skip to the next step: - this should provide you with a working 'unzip' command. - - 2. The installation of AUCTeX will require the MSYS tool set from - <http://www.mingw.org/> or the Cygwin tool set from - <https://cygwin.com/>. The latter is slower and larger (the - download size of the base system is about 15 MB) but comes with a - package manager that allows for updating the tool set and - installing additional packages like, for example, the spell checker - aspell. - - If Cygwin specific paths like '/cygdrive/c' crop up in the course - of the installation, using a non-Cygwin Emacs could conceivably - cause trouble. Using Cygwin either for everything or nothing might - save headaches, _if_ things don't work out. - - 3. Install a current version of Emacs from - <https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/emacs/windows/>. - - 4. You need a working TeX installation. One popular installation - under Windows is MiKTeX (https://miktex.org/). Another much more - extensive system is TeX Live (https://www.tug.org/texlive/) which - is rather close to its Unix cousins. - - 5. A working copy of Ghostscript (https://www.ghostscript.com/) is - required for preview-latex operation. Examining the output from - gswin32c -h - on a Windows command line should tell you whether your Ghostscript - supports the 'png16m' device needed for PNG support. MiKTeX - apparently comes with its own Ghostscript called 'mgs.exe'. - - 6. Perl (https://www.perl.org/) is needed for rebuilding the - documentation if you are working with a copy from Git or have - touched documentation source files in the preview-latex part. If - the line endings of the file 'preview/latex/preview.dtx' don't - correspond with what Perl calls '\n' when reading text files, - you'll run into trouble. - - 7. Now the fun stuff starts. If you have not yet done so, unpack the - AUCTeX distribution into a separate directory after rereading the - instructions for unpacking above. - - 8. Ready for takeoff. Start some shell (typically 'bash') capable of - running 'configure', change into the installation directory and - call './configure' with appropriate options. - - Typical options you'll want to specify will be - '--prefix=DRIVE:/PATH/TO/EMACS-HIERARCHY' - which tells 'configure' where to perform the installation. It - may also make 'configure' find Emacs automatically; if this - doesn't happen, try '--with-emacs' as described below. All - automatic detection of files and directories restricts itself - to directories below the PREFIX or in the same hierarchy as - the program accessing the files. Usually, directories like - 'man', 'share' and 'bin' will be situated right under PREFIX. - - This option also affects the defaults for placing the Texinfo - documentation files (see also '--infodir' below) and - automatically generated style hooks. - - If you have a central directory hierarchy (not untypical with - Cygwin) for such stuff, you might want to specify its root - here. You stand a good chance that this will be the only - option you need to supply, as long as your TeX-related - executables are in your system path, which they better be for - AUCTeX's operation, anyway. - - '--with-emacs' - if you are installing for a version of Emacs. You can use - '--with-emacs=DRIVE:/PATH/TO/EMACS' to specify the name of the - installed Emacs executable, complete with its path if - necessary (if Emacs is not within a directory specified in - your 'PATH' environment setting). - - '--with-lispdir=DRIVE:/PATH/TO/SITE-LISP' - This option tells a place in 'load-path' below which the files - are situated. The startup files 'auctex.el' and - 'preview-latex.el' will get installed here unless a - subdirectory 'site-start.d' exists which will then be used - instead. The other files from AUCTeX will be installed in a - subdirectory called 'auctex'. - - If you think that you need a different setup, please refer to - the full installation instructions in *note Configure::. - - '--infodir=DRIVE:/PATH/TO/INFO/DIRECTORY' - If you are installing into an Emacs directory, info files have - to be put into the 'info' folder below that directory. The - configuration script will usually try to install into the - folder 'share/info', so you have to override this by - specifying something like '--infodir='C:/Program Files/info'' - for the configure call. - - '--with-auto-dir=DRIVE:/DIR' - Directory containing automatically generated information. You - should not normally need to set this, as '--prefix' should - take care of this. - - '--disable-preview' - Use this option if your Emacs version is unable to support - image display. - - '--with-texmf-dir=DRIVE:/DIR' - This will specify the directory where your TeX installation - sits. If your TeX installation does not conform to the TDS - (TeX directory standard), you may need to specify more options - to get everything in place. - - For more information about any of the above and additional options, - see *note Configure::. - - Some executables might not be found in your path. That is not a - good idea, but you can get around by specifying environment - variables to 'configure': - GS="DRIVE:/PATH/TO/GSWIN32C.EXE" ./configure ... - should work for this purpose. 'gswin32c.exe' is the usual name for - the required _command line_ executable under Windows; in contrast, - 'gswin32.exe' is likely to fail. - - As an alternative to specifying variables for the 'configure' call - you can add directories containing the required executables to the - 'PATH' variable of your Windows system. This is especially a good - idea if Emacs has trouble finding the respective programs later - during normal operation. - - 9. Run 'make' in the installation directory. - - 10. Run 'make install' in the installation directory. - - 11. With Emacs, activation of AUCTeX and preview-latex depends on a - working 'site-start.d' directory or similar setup, since then the - startup files 'auctex.el' and 'preview-latex.el' will have been - placed there. If this has not been done, you should be able to - load the startup files manually with - (load "auctex.el" nil t t) - (load "preview-latex.el" nil t t) - in either a site-wide 'site-start.el' or your personal startup file - (usually accessible as '~/.emacs' or '~/.emacs.d/init.el' from - within Emacs). - - The default configuration of AUCTeX is probably not the best fit - for Windows systems with MiKTeX. You might want to add - (require 'tex-mik) - after loading 'auctex.el' and 'preview-latex.el' in order to get - more appropriate values for some customization options. - - You can always use - - M-x customize-group <RET> AUCTeX <RET> - - in order to customize more stuff, or use the 'Customize' menu. - - 12. Load 'circ.tex' into Emacs and see if you get the 'Command' menu. - Try using it to LaTeX the file. - - 13. Check whether the 'Preview' menu is available in this file. Use - it to generate previews for the document. - - If this barfs and tells you that image type 'png' is not supported, - you can either add PNG support to your Emacs installation or choose - another image format to be used by preview-latex. - - Adding support for an image format usually involves the - installation of a library, e.g. from <http://gnuwin32.sf.net/>. If - you got your Emacs from <https://www.gnu.org/> you might want to - check its README file - (https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/emacs/windows/README) for details. - - A different image format can be chosen by setting the variable - 'preview-image-type'. While it is recommended to keep the 'dvipng' - or 'png' setting, you can temporarily select a different format - like 'pnm' to check if the lack of PNG support is the only problem - with your Emacs installation. - - Try adding the line - - (setq preview-image-type 'pnm) - - to your init file for a quick test. You should remove the line - after the test again, because PNM files take away *vast* amounts of - disk space, and thus also of load/save time. - - Well, that about is all. Have fun! - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Customizing, Prev: Installation under MS Windows, Up: Installation - -1.2.8 Customizing ------------------ - -Most of the site-specific customization should already have happened -during configuration of AUCTeX. Any further customization can be done -with customization buffers directly in Emacs. Just type 'M-x -customize-group <RET> AUCTeX <RET>' to open the customization group for -AUCTeX or use the menu entries provided in the mode menus. Editing the -file 'tex-site.el' as suggested in former versions of AUCTeX should not -be done anymore because the installation routine will overwrite those -changes. - - You might check some options with a special significance. They are -accessible directly by typing 'M-x customize-option <RET> <option> -<RET>'. - - -- User Option: TeX-macro-global - Directories containing the site's TeX style files. - - Normally, AUCTeX will only allow you to complete macros and -environments which are built-in, specified in AUCTeX style files or -defined by yourself. If you issue the 'M-x TeX-auto-generate-global' -command after loading AUCTeX, you will be able to complete on all macros -available in the standard style files used by your document. To do -this, you must set this variable to a list of directories where the -standard style files are located. The directories will be searched -recursively, so there is no reason to list subdirectories explicitly. -Automatic configuration will already have set the variable for you if it -could use the program 'kpsewhich'. In this case you normally don't have -to alter anything. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Quick Start, Prev: Installation, Up: Introduction - -1.3 Quick Start -=============== - -AUCTeX is a powerful program offering many features and configuration -options. If you are new to AUCTeX this might be deterrent. Fortunately -you do not have to learn everything at once. This Quick Start Guide -will give you the knowledge of the most important commands and enable -you to prepare your first LaTeX document with AUCTeX after only a few -minutes of reading. - - In this introduction, we assume that AUCTeX is already installed on -your system. If this is not the case, you should read the file -'INSTALL' in the base directory of the unpacked distribution tarball. -These installation instructions are available in this manual as well, -*note Installation::. We also assume that you are familiar with the way -keystrokes are written in Emacs manuals. If not, have a look at the -Emacs Tutorial in the Help menu. - - If AUCTeX is installed in any other way than from the Emacs package -manager (ELPA), you might still need to activate it, by inserting - - (load "auctex.el" nil t t) -in your user init file.(1) - - If AUCTeX is installed from ELPA, the installation procedure already -cares about loading AUCTeX correctly and you *must not* have the line -above in your init file. Note that this also applies if you have the -following line in your init file - - (package-initialize) - - In order to get support for many of the LaTeX packages you will use -in your documents, you should enable document parsing as well, which can -be achieved by putting - - (setq TeX-auto-save t) - (setq TeX-parse-self t) -into your init file. Finally, if you often use '\include' or '\input', -you should make AUCTeX aware of the multifile document structure. You -can do this by inserting - - (setq-default TeX-master nil) - - into your init file. Each time you open a new file, AUCTeX will then -ask you for a master file. - -* Menu: - -* Editing Facilities:: Functions for editing TeX files -* Processing Facilities:: Creating and viewing output, debugging - - ---------- Footnotes ---------- - - (1) This usually is a file in your home directory called '.emacs', or -'.emacs.d/init.el'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Editing Facilities, Next: Processing Facilities, Up: Quick Start - -1.3.1 Functions for editing TeX files -------------------------------------- - -1.3.1.1 Making your TeX code more readable -.......................................... - -AUCTeX can do syntax highlighting of your source code, that means -commands will get special colors or fonts. This is enabled by default. -You can disable it locally by typing 'M-x font-lock-mode <RET>'. - - AUCTeX will indent new lines to indicate their syntactical -relationship to the surrounding text. For example, the text of a -'\footnote' or text inside of an environment will be indented relative -to the text around it. If the indenting has gotten wrong after adding -or deleting some characters, use <TAB> to reindent the line, 'M-q' for -the whole paragraph, or 'M-x LaTeX-fill-buffer <RET>' for the whole -buffer. - -1.3.1.2 Entering sectioning commands -.................................... - -Insertion of sectioning macros, that is '\chapter', '\section', -'\subsection', etc. and accompanying '\label' commands may be eased by -using 'C-c C-s'. You will be asked for the section level. As nearly -everywhere in AUCTeX, you can use the <TAB> or <SPC> key to get a list -of available level names, and to auto-complete what you started typing. -Next, you will be asked for the printed title of the section, and last -you will be asked for a label to be associated with the section. - -1.3.1.3 Inserting environments -.............................. - -Similarly, you can insert environments, that is '\begin{}'-'\end{}' -pairs: Type 'C-c C-e', and select an environment type. Again, you can -use <TAB> or <SPC> to get a list, and to complete what you type. -Actually, the list will not only provide standard LaTeX environments, -but also take your '\documentclass' and '\usepackage' commands into -account if you have parsing enabled by setting 'TeX-parse-self' to 't'. -If you use a couple of environments frequently, you can use the <up> and -<down> arrow keys (or 'M-p' and 'M-n') in the minibuffer to get back to -the previously inserted commands. - - Some environments need additional arguments. Often, AUCTeX knows -about this and asks you to enter a value. - -1.3.1.4 Inserting macros -........................ - -'C-c C-m', or simply 'C-c RET' will give you a prompt that asks you for -a LaTeX macro. You can use <TAB> for completion, or the <up>/<down> -arrow keys (or 'M-p' and 'M-n') to browse the command history. In many -cases, AUCTeX knows which arguments a macro needs and will ask you for -that. It even can differentiate between mandatory and optional -arguments--for details, see *note Completion::. - - An additional help for inserting macros is provided by the -possibility to complete macros right in the buffer. With point at the -end of a partially written macro, you can complete it by typing -'M-<TAB>'. - -1.3.1.5 Changing the font -......................... - -AUCTeX provides convenient keyboard shortcuts for inserting macros which -specify the font to be used for typesetting certain parts of the text. -They start with 'C-c C-f', and the last 'C-' combination tells AUCTeX -which font you want: - -'C-c C-f C-b' - Insert bold face '\textbf{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-i' - Insert italics '\textit{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-e' - Insert _emphasized_ '\emph{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-s' - Insert slanted '\textsl{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-r' - Insert roman '\textrm{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-f' - Insert sans serif '\textsf{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-t' - Insert typewriter '\texttt{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-c' - Insert SMALL CAPS '\textsc{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-d' - Delete the innermost font specification containing point. - - If you want to change font attributes of existing text, mark it as an -active region, and then invoke the commands. If no region is selected, -the command will be inserted with empty braces, and you can start typing -the changed text. - - Most of those commands will also work in math mode, but then macros -like '\mathbf' will be inserted. - -1.3.1.6 Other useful features -............................. - -AUCTeX also tries to help you when inserting the right "quote" signs for -your language, dollar signs to typeset math, or pairs of braces. It -offers shortcuts for commenting out text ('C-c ;' for the current region -or 'C-c %' for the paragraph you are in). The same keystrokes will -remove the % signs, if the region or paragraph is commented out yet. -With 'TeX-fold-mode', you can hide certain parts (like footnotes, -references etc.) that you do not edit currently. Support for Emacs' -outline mode is provided as well. And there's more, but this is beyond -the scope of this Quick Start Guide. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Processing Facilities, Prev: Editing Facilities, Up: Quick Start - -1.3.2 Creating and viewing output, debugging --------------------------------------------- - -1.3.2.1 One Command for LaTeX, helpers, viewers, and printing -............................................................. - -If you have typed some text and want to run LaTeX (or TeX, or other -programs--see below) on it, type 'C-c C-c'. If applicable, you will be -asked whether you want to save changes, and which program you want to -invoke. In many cases, the choice that AUCTeX suggests will be just -what you want: first 'latex', then a viewer. If a 'latex' run produces -or changes input files for 'makeindex', the next suggestion will be to -run that program, and AUCTeX knows that you need to run 'latex' again -afterwards--the same holds for BibTeX. - - When no processor invocation is necessary anymore, AUCTeX will -suggest to run a viewer, or you can chose to create a PostScript file -using 'dvips', or to directly print it. - - Actually, there is another command which comes in handy to compile -documents: type 'C-c C-a' ('TeX-command-run-all') and AUCTeX will -compile the document for you until it is ready and then run the viewer. -This is the same as issuing repeatedly 'C-c C-c' and letting AUCTeX -guess the next command to run. - - At this place, a warning needs to be given: First, although AUCTeX is -really good in detecting the standard situations when an additional -'latex' run is necessary, it cannot detect it always. Second, the -creation of PostScript files or direct printing currently only works -when your output file is a DVI file, not a PDF file. - - Ah, you didn't know you can do both? That brings us to the next -topic. - -1.3.2.2 Choosing an output format -................................. - -From a LaTeX file, you can produce DVI output, or a PDF file directly -via 'pdflatex'. You can switch on source specials for easier navigation -in the output file, or tell 'latex' to stop after an error (usually -'--noninteractive' is used, to allow you to detect all errors in a -single run). - - These options are controlled by toggles, the keystrokes should be -easy to memorize: - -'C-c C-t C-p' - This command toggles between DVI and PDF output - -'C-c C-t C-i' - toggles interactive mode - -'C-c C-t C-s' - toggles SyncTeX (or source specials) support - -'C-c C-t C-o' - toggles usage of Omega/lambda. - - There is also another possibility: compile the document with 'tex' -(or 'latex') and then convert the resulting DVI file to PDF using -'dvips'-'ps2pdf' sequence or 'dvipdfmx' command. If you want to go by -this route, customize 'TeX-PDF-from-DVI' option. Then AUCTeX will -suggest you to run the appropriate command when you type 'C-C C-c'. For -details, see *note Processor Options::. - -1.3.2.3 Debugging LaTeX -....................... - -When AUCTeX runs a program, it creates an output buffer in which it -displays the output of the command. If there is a syntactical error in -your file, 'latex' will not complete successfully. AUCTeX will tell you -that, and you can get to the place where the first error occured by -pressing 'C-c `' (the last character is a backtick). The view will be -split in two windows, the output will be displayed in the lower buffer, -and both buffers will be centered around the place where the error -ocurred. You can then try to fix it in the document buffer, and use the -same keystrokes to get to the next error. This procedure may be -repeated until all errors have been dealt with. By pressing 'C-c C-w' -('TeX-toggle-debug-boxes') you can toggle whether AUCTeX should notify -you of overfull and underfull boxes in addition to regular errors. - - Issue 'M-x TeX-error-overview <RET>' to see a nicely formatted list -of all errors and warnings reported by the compiler. - - If a command got stuck in a seemingly infinite loop, or you want to -stop execution for other reasons, you can use 'C-c C-k' (for "kill"). -Similar to 'C-l', which centers the buffer you are in around your -current position, 'C-c C-l' centers the output buffer so that the last -lines added at the bottom become visible. - -1.3.2.4 Running LaTeX on parts of your document -............................................... - -If you want to check how some part of your text looks like, and do not -want to wait until the whole document has been typeset, then mark it as -a region and use 'C-c C-r'. It behaves just like 'C-c C-c', but it only -uses the document preamble and the region you marked. - - If you are using '\include' or '\input' to structure your document, -try 'C-c C-b' while you are editing one of the included files. It will -run 'latex' only on the current buffer, using the preamble from the -master file. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Editing, Next: Display, Prev: Introduction, Up: Top - -2 Editing the Document Source -***************************** - -The most commonly used commands/macros of AUCTeX are those which simply -insert templates for often used TeX, LaTeX, or ConTeXt constructs, like -font changes, handling of environments, etc. These features are very -simple, and easy to learn, and help you avoid mistakes like mismatched -braces, or '\begin{}'-'\end{}' pairs. - - Apart from that this chapter contains a description of some features -for entering more specialized sorts of text, for formatting the source -by indenting and filling and for navigating through the document. - -* Menu: - -* Quotes:: Inserting quotes, dollars, and braces -* Font Specifiers:: Inserting Font Specifiers -* Sectioning:: Inserting chapters, sections, etc. -* Environments:: Inserting Environment Templates -* Mathematics:: Entering Mathematics -* Completion:: Completion of macros -* Marking:: Marking Environments, Sections, or Texinfo Nodes -* Commenting:: Commenting text -* Indenting:: Reflecting syntactic constructs with whitespace -* Filling:: Automatic and manual line breaking - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Quotes, Next: Font Specifiers, Up: Editing - -2.1 Insertion of Quotes, Dollars, and Braces -============================================ - -Quotation Marks ---------------- - -In TeX, literal double quotes '"like this"' are seldom used, instead two -single quotes are used '``like this'''. To help you insert these -efficiently, AUCTeX allows you to continue to press '"' to insert two -single quotes. To get a literal double quote, press '"' twice. - - -- Command: TeX-insert-quote COUNT - ('"') Insert the appropriate quote marks for TeX. - - Inserts the value of 'TeX-open-quote' (normally '``') or - 'TeX-close-quote' (normally '''') depending on the context. With - prefix argument, always inserts '"' characters. - - -- User Option: TeX-open-quote - String inserted by typing '"' to open a quotation. (*Note - European::, for language-specific quotation mark insertion.) - - -- User Option: TeX-close-quote - String inserted by typing '"' to close a quotation. (*Note - European::, for language-specific quotation mark insertion.) - - -- User Option: TeX-quote-after-quote - Determines the behavior of '"'. If it is non-nil, typing '"' will - insert a literal double quote. The respective values of - 'TeX-open-quote' and 'TeX-close-quote' will be inserted after - typing '"' once again. - - The 'babel' package provides special support for the requirements of -typesetting quotation marks in many different languages. If you use -this package, either directly or by loading a language-specific style -file, you should also use the special commands for quote insertion -instead of the standard quotes shown above. AUCTeX is able to recognize -several of these languages and will change quote insertion accordingly. -*Note European::, for details about this feature and how to control it. - - In case you are using the 'csquotes' package, you should customize -'LaTeX-csquotes-open-quote', 'LaTeX-csquotes-close-quote' and -'LaTeX-csquotes-quote-after-quote'. The quotation characters will only -be used if both variables--'LaTeX-csquotes-open-quote' and -'LaTeX-csquotes-close-quote'--are non-empty strings. But then the -'csquotes'-related values will take precedence over the -language-specific ones. - -Dollar Signs ------------- - -In AUCTeX, dollar signs should match like they do in TeX. This has been -partially implemented, we assume dollar signs always match within a -paragraph. By default, the first '$' you insert in a paragraph will do -nothing special. The second '$' will match the first. This will be -indicated by moving the cursor temporarily over the first dollar sign. - - -- Command: TeX-insert-dollar ARG - ('$') Insert dollar sign. - - Show matching dollar sign if this dollar sign end the TeX math - mode. - - With optional ARG, insert that many dollar signs. - - TeX and LaTeX users often look for a way to insert inline equations -like '$...$' or '\(...\)' simply typing '$'. AUCTeX helps them through -the customizable variable 'TeX-electric-math'. - - -- User Option: TeX-electric-math - If the variable is non-nil and you type '$' outside math mode, - AUCTeX will automatically insert the opening and closing symbols - for an inline equation and put the point between them. The opening - symbol will blink when 'blink-matching-paren' is non-nil. If - 'TeX-electric-math' is nil, typing '$' simply inserts '$' at point, - this is the default. - - Besides 'nil', possible values for this variable are '(cons "$" - "$")' for TeX inline equations '$...$', and '(cons "\\(" "\\)")' - for LaTeX inline equations '\(...\)'. - - If the variable is non-nil and point is inside math mode right - between a couple of single dollars, pressing '$' will insert - another pair of dollar signs and leave the point between them. - Thus, if 'TeX-electric-math' is set to '(cons "$" "$")' you can - easily obtain a TeX display equation '$$...$$' by pressing '$' - twice in a row. (Note that you should not use double dollar signs - in LaTeX because this practice can lead to wrong spacing in typeset - documents.) - - In addition, when the variable is non-nil and there is an active - region outside math mode, typing '$' will put around the active - region symbols for opening and closing inline equation and keep the - region active, leaving point after the closing symbol. By pressing - repeatedly '$' while the region is active you can toggle between an - inline equation, a display equation, and no equation. To be - precise, '$...$' is replaced by '$$...$$', whereas '\(...\)' is - replaced by '\[...\]'. - - If you want to automatically insert '$...$' in plain TeX files, and -'\(...\)' in LaTeX files by pressing '$', add the following to your init -file - (add-hook 'plain-TeX-mode-hook - (lambda () (set (make-local-variable 'TeX-electric-math) - (cons "$" "$")))) - (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook - (lambda () (set (make-local-variable 'TeX-electric-math) - (cons "\\(" "\\)")))) - - Note that Texinfo mode does nothing special for '$'. It inserts -dollar sign(s) just in the same way as the other normal keys do. - -Braces ------- - -To avoid unbalanced braces, it is useful to insert them pairwise. You -can do this by typing 'C-c {'. - - -- Command: TeX-insert-braces - ('C-c {') Make a pair of braces and position the cursor to type - inside of them. If there is an active region, put braces around it - and leave point after the closing brace. - - When writing complex math formulas in LaTeX documents, you sometimes -need to adjust the size of braces with pairs of macros like -'\left'-'\right', '\bigl'-'\bigr' and so on. You can avoid unbalanced -pairs with the help of 'TeX-insert-macro', bound to 'C-c C-m' or 'C-c -<RET>' (*note Completion::). If you insert left size adjusting macros -such as '\left', '\bigl' etc. with 'TeX-insert-macro', it asks for left -brace to use and supplies automatically right size adjusting macros such -as '\right', '\bigr' etc. and corresponding right brace in addtion to -the intended left macro and left brace. - - The completion by 'TeX-insert-macro' also applies when entering -macros such as '\langle', '\lfloor' and '\lceil', which produce the left -part of the paired braces. For example, inserting '\lfloor' by 'C-c -C-m' is immediately followed by the insertion of '\rfloor'. In -addition, if the point was located just after '\left' or its friends, -the corresponding '\right' etc. will be inserted in front of '\rfloor'. -In both cases, active region is honored. - - As a side effect, when 'LaTeX-math-mode' (*note Mathematics::) is on, -just typing '`(' inserts not only '\langle', but also '\rangle'. - - If you do not like such auto completion at all, it can be disabled by -a user option. - - -- User Option: TeX-arg-right-insert-p - If this option is turned off, the automatic supply of the right - macros and braces is suppressed. - - When you edit LaTeX documents, you can enable automatic brace pairing -when typing '(', '{' and '['. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-electric-left-right-brace - If this option is on, just typing '(', '{' or '[' immediately adds - the corresponding right brace ')', '}' or ']'. The point is left - after the opening brace. If there is an active region, braces are - put around it. - - They recognize the preceding backslash or size adjusting macros - such as '\left', '\bigl' etc., so the following completions will - occur: - - * (when typing single left brace) - - - '(' -> '()' - - - '{' -> '{}' - - - '[' -> '[]' - - * (when typing left brace just after a backslash) - - - '\(' -> '\(\)' - - - '\{' -> '\{\}' - - - '\[' -> '\[\]' - - * (when typing just after '\left' or '\bigl') - - - '\left(' -> '\left(\right)' - - - '\bigl[' -> '\bigl[\bigr]' - - * (when typing just after '\Bigl\') - - - '\Bigl\{' -> '\Bigl\{\Bigr\}' - - This auto completion feature may be a bit annoying when editing an - already existing LaTeX document. In that case, use 'C-u 1' or - 'C-q' before typing '(', '{' or '['. Then no completion is done - and just a single left brace is inserted. In fact, with optional - prefix ARG, just that many open braces are inserted without any - completion. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Font Specifiers, Next: Sectioning, Prev: Quotes, Up: Editing - -2.2 Inserting Font Specifiers -============================= - -Perhaps the most used keyboard commands of AUCTeX are the short-cuts -available for easy insertion of font changing macros. - - If you give an argument (that is, type 'C-u') to the font command, -the innermost font will be replaced, i.e. the font in the TeX group -around point will be changed. The following table shows the available -commands, with '-!-' indicating the position where the text will be -inserted. - -'C-c C-f C-b' - Insert bold face '\textbf{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-m' - Insert medium face '\textmd{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-i' - Insert italics '\textit{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-e' - Insert _emphasized_ '\emph{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-s' - Insert slanted '\textsl{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-r' - Insert roman '\textrm{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-f' - Insert sans serif '\textsf{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-t' - Insert typewriter '\texttt{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-c' - Insert SMALL CAPS '\textsc{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-l' - Insert upper lower case '\textulc{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-w' - Insert SWASH '\textsw{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-n' - Insert normal '\textnormal{-!-}' text. - -'C-c C-f C-d' - Delete the innermost font specification containing point. - - -- Command: TeX-font REPLACE WHAT - ('C-c C-f') Insert template for font change command. - - If REPLACE is not nil, replace current font. WHAT determines the - font to use, as specified by 'TeX-font-list'. - - -- User Option: TeX-font-list - List of fonts used by 'TeX-font'. - - Each entry is a list with three elements. The first element is the - key to activate the font. The second element is the string to - insert before point, and the third element is the string to insert - after point. An optional fourth element means always replace if - not nil. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-font-list - List of fonts used by 'TeX-font' in LaTeX mode. It has the same - structure as 'TeX-font-list'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Sectioning, Next: Environments, Prev: Font Specifiers, Up: Editing - -2.3 Inserting chapters, sections, etc. -====================================== - -Insertion of sectioning macros, that is '\chapter', '\section', -'\subsection', etc. and accompanying '\label''s may be eased by using -'C-c C-s'. This command is highly customizable, the following describes -the default behavior. - - When invoking you will be asked for a section macro to insert. An -appropriate default is automatically selected by AUCTeX, that is either: -at the top of the document; the top level sectioning for that document -style, and any other place: The same as the last occurring sectioning -command. - - Next, you will be asked for the actual name of that section, and last -you will be asked for a label to be associated with that section. The -label will be prefixed by the value specified in 'LaTeX-section-hook'. - - -- Command: LaTeX-section ARG - ('C-c C-s') Insert a sectioning command. - - Determine the type of section to be inserted, by the argument ARG. - - * If ARG is nil or missing, use the current level. - * If ARG is a list (selected by C-u), go downward one level. - * If ARG is negative, go up that many levels. - * If ARG is positive or zero, use absolute level: - + 0 : part - + 1 : chapter - + 2 : section - + 3 : subsection - + 4 : subsubsection - + 5 : paragraph - + 6 : subparagraph - - The following variables can be set to customize the function. - - 'LaTeX-section-hook' - Hooks to be run when inserting a section. - 'LaTeX-section-label' - Prefix to all section references. - - The precise behavior of 'LaTeX-section' is defined by the contents of -'LaTeX-section-hook'. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-section-hook - List of hooks to run when a new section is inserted. - - The following variables are set before the hooks are run - - 'LaTeX-level' - Numeric section level, default set by prefix arg to - 'LaTeX-section'. - 'LaTeX-name' - Name of the sectioning command, derived from 'LaTeX-level'. - 'LaTeX-title' - The title of the section, default to an empty string. - 'LaTeX-toc' - Entry for the table of contents list, default nil. - 'LaTeX-done-mark' - Position of point afterwards, default nil meaning after the - inserted text. - - A number of hooks are already defined. Most likely, you will be - able to get the desired functionality by choosing from these hooks. - - 'LaTeX-section-heading' - Query the user about the name of the sectioning command. - Modifies 'LaTeX-level' and 'LaTeX-name'. - 'LaTeX-section-title' - Query the user about the title of the section. Modifies - 'LaTeX-title'. - 'LaTeX-section-toc' - Query the user for the toc entry. Modifies 'LaTeX-toc'. - 'LaTeX-section-section' - Insert LaTeX section command according to 'LaTeX-name', - 'LaTeX-title', and 'LaTeX-toc'. If 'LaTeX-toc' is nil, no toc - entry is inserted. If 'LaTeX-toc' or 'LaTeX-title' are empty - strings, 'LaTeX-done-mark' will be placed at the point they - should be inserted. - 'LaTeX-section-label' - Insert a label after the section command. Controlled by the - variable 'LaTeX-section-label'. - - To get a full featured 'LaTeX-section' command, insert - - (setq LaTeX-section-hook - '(LaTeX-section-heading - LaTeX-section-title - LaTeX-section-toc - LaTeX-section-section - LaTeX-section-label)) - - in your init file such as 'init.el' or '.emacs'. - - The behavior of 'LaTeX-section-label' is determined by the variable -'LaTeX-section-label'. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-section-label - Default prefix when asking for a label. - - If it is a string, it is used unchanged for all kinds of sections. - If it is nil, no label is inserted. If it is a list, the list is - searched for a member whose car is equal to the name of the - sectioning command being inserted. The cdr is then used as the - prefix. If the name is not found, or if the cdr is nil, no label - is inserted. - - By default, chapters have a prefix of 'cha:' while sections and - subsections have a prefix of 'sec:'. Labels are not automatically - inserted for other types of sections. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Environments, Next: Mathematics, Prev: Sectioning, Up: Editing - -2.4 Inserting Environment Templates -=================================== - -A large apparatus is available that supports insertions of environments, -that is '\begin{}' -- '\end{}' pairs. - - AUCTeX is aware of most of the actual environments available in a -specific document. This is achieved by examining your '\documentclass' -command, and consulting a precompiled list of environments available in -a large number of styles. - - Most of these are described further in the following sections, and -you may easily specify more. *Note Customizing Environments::. - - You insert an environment with 'C-c C-e', and select an environment -type. Depending on the environment, AUCTeX may ask more questions about -the optional parts of the selected environment type. With 'C-u C-c C-e' -you will change the current environment. - - -- Command: LaTeX-environment ARG - ('C-c C-e') AUCTeX will prompt you for an environment to insert. - At this prompt, you may press <TAB> or <SPC> to complete a - partially written name, and/or to get a list of available - environments. After selection of a specific environment AUCTeX may - prompt you for further specifications. - - If the optional argument ARG is non-nil (i.e. you have given a - prefix argument), the current environment is modified and no new - environment is inserted. - - AUCTeX helps you adding labels to environments which use them, such -as 'equation', 'figure', 'table', etc... When you insert one of the -supported environments with 'C-c C-e', you will be automatically -prompted for a label. You can select the prefix to be used for such -environments with the 'LaTeX-label-alist' variable. - -- User Option: LaTeX-label-alist - List the prefixes to be used for the label of each supported - environment. - - This is an alist whose car is the environment name, and the cdr - either the prefix or a symbol referring to one. - - If the name is not found, or if the cdr is nil, no label is - automatically inserted for that environment. - - If you want to automatically insert a label for a environment but - with an empty prefix, use the empty string '""' as the cdr of the - corresponding entry. - - As a default selection, AUCTeX will suggest the environment last -inserted or, as the first choice the value of the variable -'LaTeX-default-environment'. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-default-environment - Default environment to insert when invoking 'LaTeX-environment' - first time. When the current environment is 'document', it is - overriden by 'LaTeX-default-document-environment'. - - -- Variable: LaTeX-default-document-environment - Default environment when invoking 'LaTeX-environment' and the - current environment is 'document'. It is intended to be used in - LaTeX class style files. For example, in 'beamer.el' it is set to - 'frame', in 'letter.el' to 'letter', and in 'slides.el' to 'slide'. - - If the document is empty, or the cursor is placed at the top of the -document, AUCTeX will default to insert a 'document' environment -prompting also for the insertion of '\documentclass' and '\usepackage' -macros. You will be prompted for a new package until you enter nothing. -If you do not want to insert any '\usepackage' at all, just press <RET> -at the first 'Packages' prompt. - - AUCTeX distinguishes normal and expert environments. By default, it -will offer completion only for normal environments. This behavior is -controlled by the user option 'TeX-complete-expert-commands'. - - -- User Option: TeX-complete-expert-commands - Complete macros and environments marked as expert commands. - - Possible values are nil, t, or a list of style names. - - nil - Don't complete expert commands (default). - t - Always complete expert commands. - (STYLES ...) - Only complete expert commands of STYLES. - -* Menu: - -* Equations:: Equations -* Floats:: Floats -* Itemize-like:: Itemize-like Environments -* Tabular-like:: Tabular-like Environments -* Customizing Environments:: Customizing Environments - - You can close the current environment with 'C-c ]', but we suggest -that you use 'C-c C-e' to insert complete environments instead. - - -- Command: LaTeX-close-environment - ('C-c ]') Insert an '\end' that matches the current environment. - - AUCTeX offers keyboard shortcuts for moving point to the beginning -and to the end of the current environment. - -- Command: LaTeX-find-matching-begin - ('C-M-a') Move point to the '\begin' of the current environment. - - If this command is called inside a comment and - 'LaTeX-syntactic-comments' is enabled, try to find the environment - in commented regions with the same comment prefix. - - -- Command: LaTeX-find-matching-end - ('C-M-e') Move point to the '\end' of the current environment. - - If this command is called inside a comment and - 'LaTeX-syntactic-comments' is enabled, try to find the environment - in commented regions with the same comment prefix. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Equations, Next: Floats, Up: Environments - -2.4.1 Equations ---------------- - -When inserting equation-like environments, the '\label' will have a -default prefix, which is controlled by the following variables: - - -- User Option: LaTeX-equation-label - Prefix to use for 'equation' labels. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-eqnarray-label - Prefix to use for 'eqnarray' labels. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-amsmath-label - Prefix to use for amsmath equation labels. Amsmath equations - include 'align', 'alignat', 'xalignat', 'multline', 'flalign' and - 'gather'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Floats, Next: Itemize-like, Prev: Equations, Up: Environments - -2.4.2 Floats ------------- - -Figures and tables (i.e., floats) may also be inserted using AUCTeX. -After choosing either 'figure' or 'table' in the environment list -described above, you will be prompted for a number of additional things. - -FLOAT POSITION - This is the optional argument of float environments that controls - how they are placed in the final document. In LaTeX this is a - sequence of the letters 'htbp' as described in the LaTeX manual. - The value will default to the value of 'LaTeX-float'. - -CAPTION - This is the caption of the float. The default is to insert the - caption at the bottom of the float. You can specify floats where - the caption should be placed at the top with - 'LaTeX-top-caption-list'. - -SHORT CAPTION - If the specified caption is greater than a specific length, then a - short caption is prompted for and it is inserted as an optional - argument to the '\caption' macro. The length that a caption needs - to be before prompting for a short version is controlled by - 'LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length'. - -LABEL - The label of this float. The label will have a default prefix, - which is controlled by the variables 'LaTeX-figure-label' and - 'LaTeX-table-label'. - - Moreover, you will be asked if you want the contents of the float -environment to be horizontally centered. Upon a positive answer a -'\centering' macro will be inserted at the beginning of the float -environment. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-float - Default placement for floats. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-figure-label - Prefix to use for figure labels. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-table-label - Prefix to use for table labels. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-top-caption-list - List of float environments with top caption. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length - Number of chars a caption should be before prompting for a short - caption. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Itemize-like, Next: Tabular-like, Prev: Floats, Up: Environments - -2.4.3 Itemize-like Environments -------------------------------- - -In an itemize-like environment, nodes (i.e., '\item's) may be inserted -using 'C-c <LFD>'. - - -- Command: LaTeX-insert-item - ('C-c <LFD>') Close the current item, move to the next line and - insert an appropriate '\item' for the current environment. That - is, 'itemize' and 'enumerate' will have '\item ' inserted, while - 'description' will have '\item[] ' inserted. - - -- User Option: TeX-arg-item-label-p - If non-nil, you will always be asked for optional label in items. - Otherwise, you will be asked only in description environments. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Tabular-like, Next: Customizing Environments, Prev: Itemize-like, Up: Environments - -2.4.4 Tabular-like Environments -------------------------------- - -When inserting Tabular-like environments, that is, 'tabular' 'array' -etc., you will be prompted for a template for that environment. Related -variables: - - -- User Option: LaTeX-default-format - Default format string for array and tabular environments. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-default-width - Default width for minipage and tabular* environments. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-default-position - Default position string for array and tabular environments. If - nil, act like the empty string is given, but don't prompt for a - position. - - AUCTeX calculates the number of columns from the format string and -inserts the suitable number of ampersands. - - You can use 'C-c <LFD>' ('LaTeX-insert-item') to terminate rows in -these environments. It supplies line break macro '\\' and inserts the -suitable number of ampersands on the next line. AUCTeX also supports -the '*{num}{cols}' notation (which may contain another '*'-expression) -in the format string when calculating the number of ampersands. Please -note that 'num' and 'cols' must be enclosed in braces; expressions like -'*2l' are not recognized correctly by the algorithm. - - -- Command: LaTeX-insert-item - ('C-c <LFD>') Close the current row with '\\', move to the next - line and insert an appropriate number of ampersands for the current - environment. - - Similar supports are provided for various amsmath environments such -as 'align', 'gather', 'alignat', 'matrix' etc. Try typing 'C-c <LFD>' -in these environments. It recognizes the current environment and does -the appropriate job depending on the context. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Customizing Environments, Prev: Tabular-like, Up: Environments - -2.4.5 Customizing Environments ------------------------------- - -*Note Adding Environments::, for how to customize the list of known -environments. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Mathematics, Next: Completion, Prev: Environments, Up: Editing - -2.5 Entering Mathematics -======================== - -TeX is written by a mathematician, and has always contained good support -for formatting mathematical text. AUCTeX supports this tradition, by -offering a special minor mode for entering text with many mathematical -symbols. You can enter this mode by typing 'C-c ~'. - - -- Command: LaTeX-math-mode - ('C-c ~') Toggle LaTeX Math mode. This is a minor mode rebinding - the key 'LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix' to allow easy typing of - mathematical symbols. '`' will read a character from the keyboard, - and insert the symbol as specified in 'LaTeX-math-default' and - 'LaTeX-math-list'. If given a prefix argument, the symbol will be - surrounded by dollar signs. - - You can use another prefix key (instead of '`') by setting the -variable 'LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix'. - - To enable LaTeX Math mode by default, add the following in your init -file such as 'init.el' or '.emacs': - (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook #'LaTeX-math-mode) - - -- User Option: LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix - A string containing the prefix of 'LaTeX-math-mode' commands; This - value defaults to '`'. - - The string has to be a key or key sequence in a format understood - by the 'kbd' macro. This corresponds to the syntax usually used in - the manuals for Emacs Lisp. - - The variable 'LaTeX-math-list' allows you to add your own mappings. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-math-list - A list containing user-defined keys and commands to be used in - LaTeX Math mode. Each entry should be a list of two to four - elements. - - First, the key to be used after 'LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix' for - macro insertion. The key can be a character (e.g. '?o') for a - single stroke or a string (e.g. '"o a"') for a multi-stroke - binding. If it is nil, the symbol has no associated keystroke (it - is available in the menu, though). - - Second, a string representing the name of the macro (without a - leading backslash.) - - Third, a string representing the name of a submenu the command - should be added to. Use a list of strings in case of nested menus. - - Fourth, the position of a Unicode character to be displayed in the - menu alongside the macro name. This is an integer value. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-math-menu-unicode - Whether the LaTeX Math menu should try using Unicode for effect. - Your Emacs built must be able to display include Unicode characters - in menus for this feature. - - AUCTeX's reference card 'tex-ref.tex' includes a list of all math -mode commands. - - AUCTeX can help you write subscripts and superscripts in math -constructs by automatically inserting a pair of braces after typing <_> -or <^> respectively and putting point between the braces. In order to -enable this feature, set the variable 'TeX-electric-sub-and-superscript' -to a non-nil value. - - -- User Option: TeX-electric-sub-and-superscript - If non-nil, insert braces after typing <^> and <_> in math mode. - - You can automatically turn off input methods, used to input non-ascii -characters, when you begin to enter math constructs. - - -- User Option: TeX-math-input-method-off-regexp - Input method matching this regular expression is turned off when - '$' is typed to begin math mode or a math environment is inserted - by 'C-c C-e' ('LaTeX-environment'). - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Completion, Next: Marking, Prev: Mathematics, Up: Editing - -2.6 Completion -============== - -Emacs lisp programmers probably know the 'lisp-complete-symbol' command -which was bound to 'M-<TAB>' until completion-at-point became the new -standard completion facility (see below). Users of the wonderful ispell -mode know and love the 'ispell-complete-word' command from that package. -Similarly, AUCTeX has a 'TeX-complete-symbol' command, by default bound -to 'M-<TAB>' which is equivalent to 'C-M-i'. Using -'TeX-complete-symbol' makes it easier to type and remember the names of -long LaTeX macros. - - In order to use 'TeX-complete-symbol', you should write a backslash -and the start of the macro. Typing 'M-<TAB>' will now complete as much -of the macro, as it unambiguously can. For example, if you type -''\renewc'' and then 'M-<TAB>', it will expand to ''\renewcommand''. -But there's more: if point is just after '\begin{', then -'TeX-complete-symbol' will complete LaTeX environments, etc. This is -controlled by 'TeX-complete-list'. - - -- Command: TeX-complete-symbol - ('M-<TAB>') Complete TeX symbol before point. - - -- Variable: TeX-complete-list - List of ways to complete the preceding text. - - Each entry is a list with the following elements: - - 1. Regexp matching the preceding text or a predicate of arity 0 - which returns non-nil and sets 'match-data' appropriately if - it is applicable. - 2. A number indicating the subgroup in the regexp containing the - text. - 3. A function returning an alist of possible completions. - 4. Text to append after a succesful completion. - - Or alternatively: - - 1. Regexp matching the preceding text. - 2. Function to do the actual completion. - - More recent Emacs versions have a new completion mechanism. Modes -may define and register custom 'completion-at-point' functions and when -the user invokes 'completion-at-point' (usually bound to 'M-<TAB>'), all -such registered functions are consulted for checking for possible -completions. Modern completion UIs like company-mode support this -completion-at-point facility. - - -- Function: TeX--completion-at-point - AUCTeX's completion-at-point function which is automatically added - to 'completion-at-point-functions' in TeX and LaTeX buffers. - - It offers the same completion candidates as would - 'TeX-complete-symbol' (and is also controlled by - 'TeX-complete-list') except that it doesn't fall back on - 'ispell-complete-word' which would be awkward with completion UIs - like company-mode. - - A more direct way to insert a macro is with 'TeX-insert-macro', bound -to 'C-c C-m' which is equivalent to 'C-c <RET>'. It has the advantage -over completion that it knows about the argument of most standard LaTeX -macros, and will prompt for them. It also knows about the type of the -arguments, so it will for example give completion for the argument to -'\include'. Some examples are listed below. - - -- Command: TeX-insert-macro - ('C-c C-m' or 'C-c <RET>') Prompt (with completion) for the name of - a TeX macro, and if AUCTeX knows the macro, prompt for each - argument. - - As a default selection, AUCTeX will suggest the macro last inserted -or, as the first choice the value of the variable 'TeX-default-macro'. - - -- User Option: TeX-default-macro - Default macro to insert when invoking 'TeX-insert-macro' first - time. - - -- User Option: TeX-insert-macro-default-style - Specifies whether 'TeX-insert-macro' will ask for all optional - arguments. - - If set to the symbol 'show-optional-args', 'TeX-insert-macro' asks - for optional arguments of TeX marcos, unless the previous optional - argument has been rejected. If set to 'show-all-optional-args', - 'TeX-insert-macro' asks for all optional arguments. - 'mandatory-args-only', 'TeX-insert-macro' asks only for mandatory - arguments. When 'TeX-insert-macro' is called with prefix argument - ('C-u'), it's the other way round. - - Note that for some macros, there are special mechanisms, e.g. - 'TeX-arg-cite-note-p' and 'LaTeX-includegraphics-options-alist'. - - A faster alternative is to enable the option 'TeX-electric-escape'. - - -- User Option: TeX-electric-escape - If this is non-nil, typing the TeX escape character '\' will invoke - the command 'TeX-electric-macro'. - - In Texinfo mode, the command is invoked by '@' instead. - - The difference between 'TeX-insert-macro' and 'TeX-electric-macro' is -that space key <SPC> will complete and exit from the minibuffer in -'TeX-electric-macro'. Use <TAB> if you merely want to complete. - - -- Command: TeX-electric-macro - Prompt (with completion) for the name of a TeX macro, and if AUCTeX - knows the macro, prompt for each argument. Space (<SPC>) will - complete and exit. - - By default AUCTeX will put an empty set braces '{}' after a macro -with no arguments to stop it from eating the next whitespace. This is -suppressed inside math mode and can be disabled totally by setting -'TeX-insert-braces' to nil. - - -- User Option: TeX-insert-braces - If non-nil, append a empty pair of braces after inserting a macro - with no arguments. - - -- User Option: TeX-insert-braces-alist - Control the insertion of a pair of braces after a macro on a per - macro basis. - - This variable is an alist. Each element is a cons cell, whose car - is the macro name, and the cdr is non-nil or nil, depending on - whether a pair of braces should be, respectively, appended or not - to the macro. - - If a macro has an element in this variable, AUCTeX will use its - value to decide what to do, whatever the value of the variable - 'TeX-insert-braces'. - - Completions work because AUCTeX can analyze TeX files, and store -symbols in Emacs Lisp files for later retrieval. *Note Automatic::, for -more information. - - AUCTeX distinguishes normal and expert macros. By default, it will -offer completion only for normal commands. This behavior can be -controlled using the user option 'TeX-complete-expert-commands'. - - -- User Option: TeX-complete-expert-commands - Complete macros and environments marked as expert commands. - - Possible values are nil, t, or a list of style names. - - nil - Don't complete expert commands (default). - t - Always complete expert commands. - (STYLES ...) - Only complete expert commands of STYLES. - - AUCTeX will also make completion for many macro arguments, for -example existing labels when you enter a '\ref' macro with -'TeX-insert-macro' or 'TeX-electric-macro', and BibTeX entries when you -enter a '\cite' macro. For this kind of completion to work, parsing -must be enabled as described in *note Parsing Files::. For '\cite' you -must also make sure that the BibTeX files have been saved at least once -after you enabled automatic parsing on save, and that the basename of -the BibTeX file does not conflict with the basename of one of TeX files. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Marking, Next: Commenting, Prev: Completion, Up: Editing - -2.7 Marking Environments, Sections, or Texinfo Nodes -==================================================== - -You can mark the current environment by typing 'C-c .', or the current -section by typing 'C-c *'. - - In Texinfo documents you can type 'C-M-h' to mark the current node. - - When the region is set, the point is moved to its beginning and the -mark to its end. - -* Menu: - -* Marking (LaTeX):: LaTeX Commands for Marking Environments and Sections -* Marking (Texinfo):: Texinfo Commands for Marking Environments, Sections, and Nodes - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Marking (LaTeX), Next: Marking (Texinfo), Up: Marking - -2.7.1 LaTeX Commands for Marking Environments and Sections ----------------------------------------------------------- - - -- Command: LaTeX-mark-section - ('C-c *') Set mark at end of current logical section, and point at - top. - - With a non-nil prefix argument, mark only the region from the - current section start to the next sectioning command. Thereby - subsections are not being marked. Otherwise, any included - subsections are also marked along with current section. - - -- Command: LaTeX-mark-environment - ('C-c .') Set mark to the end of the current environment and point - to the matching beginning. - - If a prefix argument is given, mark the respective number of - enclosing environments. The command will not work properly if - there are unbalanced begin-end pairs in comments and verbatim - environments. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Marking (Texinfo), Prev: Marking (LaTeX), Up: Marking - -2.7.2 Texinfo Commands for Marking Environments and Sections ------------------------------------------------------------- - - -- Command: Texinfo-mark-section - ('C-c *') Mark the current section, with inclusion of any - containing node. - - The current section is detected as starting by any of the - structuring commands matched by the regular expression in the - variable 'outline-regexp' which in turn is a regular expression - matching any element of the variable 'texinfo-section-list'. - - With a non-nil prefix argument, mark only the region from the - current section start to the next sectioning command. Thereby - subsections are not being marked. Otherwise, any included - subsections are also marked. - - Note that when the current section is starting immediately after a - node command, then the node command is also marked as part of the - section. - - -- Command: Texinfo-mark-environment - ('C-c .') Set mark to the end of the current environment and point - to the matching beginning. - - If a prefix argument is given, mark the respective number of - enclosing environments. The command will not work properly if - there are unbalanced begin-end pairs in comments and verbatim - environments. - - -- Command: Texinfo-mark-node - ('C-M-h') Mark the current node. This is the node in which point - is located. It is starting at the previous occurrence of the - keyword '@node' and ending at next occurrence of the keywords - '@node' or '@bye'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Commenting, Next: Indenting, Prev: Marking, Up: Editing - -2.8 Commenting -============== - -It is often necessary to comment out temporarily a region of TeX or -LaTeX code. This can be done with the commands 'C-c ;' and 'C-c %'. -'C-c ;' will comment out all lines in the current region, while 'C-c %' -will comment out the current paragraph. Type 'C-c ;' again to uncomment -all lines of a commented region, or 'C-c %' again to uncomment all -comment lines around point. These commands will insert or remove a -single '%' respectively. - - -- Command: TeX-comment-or-uncomment-region - ('C-c ;') Add or remove '%' from the beginning of each line in the - current region. Uncommenting works only if the region encloses - solely commented lines. If AUCTeX should not try to guess if the - region should be commented or uncommented the commands - 'TeX-comment-region' and 'TeX-uncomment-region' can be used to - explicitly comment or uncomment the region in concern. - - -- Command: TeX-comment-or-uncomment-paragraph - ('C-c %') Add or remove '%' from the beginning of each line in the - current paragraph. When removing '%' characters the paragraph is - considered to consist of all preceding and succeeding lines - starting with a '%', until the first non-comment line. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Indenting, Next: Filling, Prev: Commenting, Up: Editing - -2.9 Indenting -============= - -Indentation means the addition of whitespace at the beginning of lines -to reflect special syntactical constructs. This makes it easier to see -the structure of the document, and to catch errors such as a missing -closing brace. Thus, the indentation is done for precisely the same -reasons that you would indent ordinary computer programs. - - Indentation is done by LaTeX environments and by TeX groups, that is -the body of an environment is indented by the value of -'LaTeX-indent-level' (default 2). Also, items of an 'itemize-like' -environment are indented by the value of 'LaTeX-item-indent', default --2. (Items are identified with the help of 'LaTeX-item-regexp'.) If -more environments are nested, they are indented 'accumulated' just like -most programming languages usually are seen indented in nested -constructs. - - You can explicitly indent single lines, usually by pressing <TAB>, or -marked regions by calling 'indent-region' on it. If you have -'auto-fill-mode' enabled and a line is broken while you type it, Emacs -automatically cares about the indentation in the following line. If you -want to have a similar behavior upon typing <RET>, you can customize the -variable 'TeX-newline-function' and change the default of 'newline' -which does no indentation to 'newline-and-indent' which indents the new -line or 'reindent-then-newline-and-indent' which indents both the -current and the new line. - - There are certain LaTeX environments which should be indented in a -special way, like 'tabular' or 'verbatim'. Those environments may be -specified in the variable 'LaTeX-indent-environment-list' together with -their special indentation functions. Taking the 'verbatim' environment -as an example you can see that 'current-indentation' is used as the -indentation function. This will stop AUCTeX from doing any indentation -in the environment if you hit <TAB> for example. - - There are environments in 'LaTeX-indent-environment-list' which do -not bring a special indentation function with them. This is due to the -fact that first the respective functions are not implemented yet and -second that filling will be disabled for the specified environments. -This shall prevent the source code from being messed up by accidently -filling those environments with the standard filling routine. If you -think that providing special filling routines for such environments -would be an appropriate and challenging task for you, you are invited to -contribute. (*Note Filling::, for further information about the filling -functionality.) - - The check for the indentation function may be enabled or disabled by -customizing the variable 'LaTeX-indent-environment-check'. - - For tabular-like environments, AUCTeX has a built-in function to -indent according to preceding '&' signs and assigns it to all known -tabular-like environments in the default value of -'LaTeX-indent-environment-list'. - - As a side note with regard to formatting special environments: Newer -Emacsen include 'align.el' and therefore provide some support for -formatting 'tabular' and 'tabbing' environments with the function -'align-current' which will nicely align columns in the source code. - - AUCTeX is able to format commented parts of your code just as any -other part. This means LaTeX environments and TeX groups in comments -will be indented syntactically correct if the variable -'LaTeX-syntactic-comments' is set to t. If you disable it, comments -will be filled like normal text and no syntactic indentation will be -done. - - Following you will find a list of most commands and variables related -to indenting with a small summary in each case: - -'<TAB>' - 'LaTeX-indent-line' will indent the current line. - -'<LFD>' -'C-j' - 'newline-and-indent' inserts a new line (much like <RET>) and moves - the cursor to an appropriate position by the left margin. - - Most keyboards nowadays lack a linefeed key and 'C-j' may be - tedious to type. Therefore you can customize AUCTeX to perform - indentation upon typing <RET> as well. The respective option is - called 'TeX-newline-function'. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-indent-environment-list - List of environments with special indentation. The second element - in each entry is the function to calculate the indentation level in - columns. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-indent-level - Number of spaces to add to the indentation for each '\begin' not - matched by a '\end'. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-item-indent - Number of spaces to add to the indentation for '\item''s in list - environments. - - -- User Option: TeX-brace-indent-level - Number of spaces to add to the indentation for each '{' not matched - by a '}'. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-syntactic-comments - If non-nil comments will be filled and indented according to LaTeX - syntax. Otherwise they will be filled like normal text. - - -- User Option: TeX-newline-function - Used to specify the function which is called when <RET> is pressed. - This will normally be 'newline' which simply inserts a new line. - In case you want to have AUCTeX do indentation as well when you - press <RET>, use the built-in functions 'newline-and-indent' or - 'reindent-then-newline-and-indent'. The former inserts a new line - and indents the following line, i.e. it moves the cursor to the - right position and therefore acts as if you pressed <LFD>. The - latter function additionally indents the current line. If you - choose 'Other', you can specify your own fancy function to be - called when <RET> is pressed. - - AUCTeX treats by default '\[...\]' math mode as a regular environment -and indents it accordingly. If you do not like such behavior you only -need to remove '\|\[' and '\|\]' from 'LaTeX-begin-regexp' and -'LaTeX-end-regexp' variables respectively. - - A closely related topic is indenting of text enclosed in square -brackets, parentheses and other pairs. AUCTeX offers two variables -which control if indentation happens inside these pairs. - - -- User Option: TeX-indent-open-delimiters - This variable contains additional opening delimiters which increase - indentation. For example add '[' to this variable to get text - after a square bracket indented. - - -- User Option: TeX-indent-close-delimiters - This is the accompanying variable to 'TeX-indent-open-delimiters' - decreasing the indentation again. This variable should contain ']' - if 'TeX-indent-open-delimiters' is set like described above. - -Note that this is an opt-in feature, both variables are initially set to -an empty string. That is because it introduces non-trivial side effects -to include '[' and ']' in 'TeX-indent-open-delimiters' and -'TeX-indent-close-delimiters'; if you only have an opening square -bracket in your text without closing it, wrong indentation persists in -the following text. For example, in math expression, half-open -intervals are frequently written as '[0,10)' or '[0,10['. In such -cases, you can put the closing part as a comment in the same line in -order to have correct indentation after that: - $[0,10)$ % ] - $[0,10[$ % ]] - - Another example is '\left'-'\right' pair in equations. Similar -workarounds are available: - \begin{equation} - \left[ % ] - xyz - \right] % [ - abc - \end{equation} - - You can include parens '()' also in 'TeX-indent-open-delimiters' and -'TeX-indent-close-delimiters' to enable indent inside them. Be prepared -for similar side effects when you do. - - Note that commented curly braces '{' and '}' aren't counted when -AUCTeX computes indentation. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Filling, Prev: Indenting, Up: Editing - -2.10 Filling -============ - -Filling deals with the insertion of line breaks to prevent lines from -becoming wider than what is specified in 'fill-column'. The linebreaks -will be inserted automatically if 'auto-fill-mode' is enabled. In this -case the source is not only filled but also indented automatically as -you write it. - - 'auto-fill-mode' can be enabled for AUCTeX by calling -'turn-on-auto-fill' in one of the hooks AUCTeX is running. *Note Modes -and Hooks::. As an example, if you want to enable 'auto-fill-mode' in -'LaTeX-mode', put the following into your init file: - - (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook #'turn-on-auto-fill) - - You can manually fill explicitly marked regions, paragraphs, -environments, complete sections, or the whole buffer. (Note that manual -filling in AUCTeX will indent the start of the region to be filled in -contrast to many other Emacs modes.) - - There are some syntactical constructs which are handled specially -with regard to filling. These are so-called "code comments" and -"paragraph commands". - - Code comments are comments preceded by code or text in the same line. -Upon filling a region, code comments themselves will not get filled. -Filling is done from the start of the region to the line with the code -comment and continues after it. In order to prevent overfull lines in -the source code, a linebreak will be inserted before the last -non-comment word by default. This can be changed by customizing -'LaTeX-fill-break-before-code-comments'. If you have overfull lines -with code comments you can fill those explicitly by calling -'LaTeX-fill-paragraph' or pressing 'M-q' with the cursor positioned on -them. This will add linebreaks in the comment and indent subsequent -comment lines to the column of the comment in the first line of the code -comment. In this special case 'M-q' only acts on the current line and -not on the whole paragraph. - - Lines with '\par' are treated similarly to code comments, i.e. '\par' -will be treated as paragraph boundary which should not be followed by -other code or text. But it is not treated as a real paragraph boundary -like an empty line where filling a paragraph would stop. - - Paragraph commands like '\section' or '\noindent' (the list of -commands is defined by 'LaTeX-paragraph-commands') are often to be -placed in their own line(s). This means they should not be consecuted -with any preceding or following adjacent lines of text. AUCTeX will -prevent this from happening if you do not put any text except another -macro after the end of the last brace of the respective macro. If there -is other text after the macro, AUCTeX regards this as a sign that the -macro is part of the following paragraph. - - Here are some examples: - - \begin{quote} - text text text text - - \begin{quote}\label{foo} - text text text text - - If you press 'M-q' on the first line in both examples, nothing will -change. But if you write - - \begin{quote} text - text text text text -and press 'M-q', you will get - - \begin{quote} text text text text text - - Besides code comments and paragraph commands, another speciality of -filling in AUCTeX involves commented lines. You should be aware that -these comments are treated as islands in the rest of the LaTeX code if -syntactic filling is enabled. This means, for example, if you try to -fill an environment with 'LaTeX-fill-environment' and have the cursor -placed on a commented line which does not have a surrounding environment -inside the comment, AUCTeX will report an error. - - The relevant commands and variables with regard to filling are: - -'C-c C-q C-p' - 'LaTeX-fill-paragraph' will fill and indent the current paragraph. - -'M-q' - Alias for 'C-c C-q C-p' - -'C-c C-q C-e' - 'LaTeX-fill-environment' will fill and indent the current - environment. This may e.g. be the 'document' environment, in which - case the entire document will be formatted. - -'C-c C-q C-s' - 'LaTeX-fill-section' will fill and indent the current logical - sectional unit. - -'C-c C-q C-r' - 'LaTeX-fill-region' will fill and indent the current region. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-fill-break-at-separators - List of separators before or after which respectively linebreaks - will be inserted if they do not fit into one line. The separators - can be curly braces, brackets, switches for inline math ('$', '\(', - '\)') and switches for display math ('\[', '\]'). Such formatting - can be useful to make macros and math more visible or to prevent - overfull lines in the LaTeX source in case a package for displaying - formatted TeX output inside the Emacs buffer, like preview-latex, - is used. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-fill-break-before-code-comments - Code comments are comments preceded by some other text in the same - line. When a paragraph containing such a comment is to be filled, - the comment start will be seen as a border after which no line - breaks will be inserted in the same line. If the option - 'LaTeX-fill-break-before-code-comments' is enabled (which is the - default) and the comment does not fit into the line, a line break - will be inserted before the last non-comment word to minimize the - chance that the line becomes overfull. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-fill-excluded-macros - A list of macro names (without leading backslash) for whose - arguments filling should be disabled. Typically, you will want to - add macros here which have long, multi-line arguments. An example - is '\pgfplotstabletypeset' from the pgfplotstable package which is - used as shown in the following listing: - - \pgfplotstabletypeset[skip first n=4]{% - XYZ Format, - Version 1.234 - Date 2010-09-01 - @author Mustermann - A B C - 1 2 3 - 4 5 6 - } - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Display, Next: Processing, Prev: Editing, Up: Top - -3 Controlling Screen Display -**************************** - -It is often desirable to get visual help of what markup code in a text -actually does without having to decipher it explicitly. For this -purpose Emacs and AUCTeX provide font locking (also known as syntax -highlighting) which visually sets off markup code like macros or -environments by using different colors or fonts. For example text to be -typeset in italics can be displayed with an italic font in the editor as -well, or labels and references get their own distinct color. - - While font locking helps you grasp the purpose of markup code and -separate markup from content, the markup code can still be distracting. -AUCTeX lets you hide those parts and show them again at request with its -built-in support for hiding macros and environments which we call -folding here. - - Besides folding of macros and environments, AUCTeX provides support -for Emacs' outline mode which lets you narrow the buffer content to -certain sections of your text by hiding the parts not belonging to these -sections. - - Moreover, you can focus in a specific portion of the code by -narrowing the buffer to the desired region. AUCTeX provides also -functions to narrow the buffer to the current group and to LaTeX -environments. - - AUCTeX also provides some WYSIWYG features. - - First, you can customize 'font-latex-fontify-script' to enable -special formatting of '^' superscripts and '_' subscripts (*note Font -Locking::). - - Secondly, AUCTeX with GNU Emacs 25 or later can display certain math -macros using Unicode characters, e.g., '\alpha' as α. This is called -prettification and is lightweight and reasonable robust (*note -Prettifying::). - - A more accurate approach is provided by preview-latex, a subsystem of -AUCTeX, see *note Introduction: (preview-latex)Top. This system uses -LaTeX to generate images that are then displayed in your buffer. It is -extremely accurate but can be fragile with some packages (like older pgf -versions). - - Please note that you can use prettification and preview-latex -together. - -* Menu: - -* Font Locking:: Font Locking -* Folding:: Folding Macros and Environments -* Outline:: Outlining the Document -* Narrowing:: Restricting display and editing to a portion of the buffer -* Prettifying:: Displaying Greek and math macros as Unicode characters - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Font Locking, Next: Folding, Up: Display - -3.1 Font Locking -================ - -Font locking is supposed to improve readability of the source code by -highlighting certain keywords with different colors or fonts. It -thereby lets you recognize the function of markup code to a certain -extent without having to read the markup command. For general -information on controlling font locking with Emacs' Font Lock mode, see -*note Font Lock Mode: (emacs)Font Lock. - - -- User Option: TeX-install-font-lock - Once font locking is enabled globally or for the major modes - provided by AUCTeX, the font locking patterns and functionality of - font-latex are activated by default. You can switch to a different - font locking scheme or disable font locking in AUCTeX by - customizing the variable 'TeX-install-font-lock'. - - Besides font-latex AUCTeX ships with a scheme which is derived from - Emacs' default LaTeX mode and activated by choosing - 'tex-font-setup'. Be aware that this scheme is not coupled with - AUCTeX's style system and not the focus of development. Therefore - and due to font-latex being much more feature-rich the following - explanations will only cover font-latex. - - In case you want to hook in your own fontification scheme, you can - choose 'other' and insert the name of the function which sets up - your font locking patterns. If you want to disable fontification - in AUCTeX completely, choose 'ignore'. - - font-latex provides many options for customization which are -accessible with 'M-x customize-group <RET> font-latex <RET>'. For this -description the various options are explained in conceptional groups. - -* Menu: - -* Fontification of macros:: Fontification of macros -* Fontification of quotes:: Fontification of quotes -* Fontification of math:: Fontification of math constructs -* Verbatim content:: Verbatim macros and environments -* Faces:: Faces used by font-latex -* Known problems:: Known fontification problems - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Fontification of macros, Next: Fontification of quotes, Up: Font Locking - -3.1.1 Fontification of macros ------------------------------ - -Highlighting of macros can be customized by adapting keyword lists which -can be found in the customization group 'font-latex-keywords'. - - Three types of macros can be handled differently with respect to -fontification: - - 1. Commands of the form '\foo[bar]{baz}' which consist of the macro - itself, optional arguments in square brackets and mandatory - arguments in curly braces. For the command itself the face - 'font-lock-keyword-face' will be used and for the optional - arguments the face 'font-lock-variable-name-face'. The face - applied to the mandatory argument depends on the macro class - represented by the respective built-in variables. - 2. Declaration macros of the form '{\foo text}' which consist of the - macro which may be enclosed in a TeX group together with text to be - affected by the macro. In case a TeX group is present, the macro - will get the face 'font-lock-keyword-face' and the text will get - the face configured for the respective macro class. If no TeX - group is present, the latter face will be applied to the macro - itself. - 3. Simple macros of the form '\foo' which do not have any arguments or - groupings. The respective face will be applied to the macro - itself. - - Customization variables for '\foo[bar]{baz}' type macros allow both -the macro name and the sequence of arguments to be specified. The -latter is done with a string which can contain the characters -'*' - indicating the existence of a starred variant for the macro, -'[' - for optional arguments in brackets, -'{' - for mandatory arguments in braces, -'\' - for mandatory arguments consisting of a single macro and -'|' - as a prefix indicating that two alternatives are following. - For example the specifier for '\documentclass' would be '[{' because -the macro has one optional followed by one mandatory argument. The -specifier for '\newcommand' would be '*|{\[[{' because there is a -starred variant, the mandatory argument following the macro name can be -a macro or a TeX group which can be followed by two optional arguments -and the last token is a mandatory argument in braces. - - Customization variables for the '{\foo text}' and '\foo' types are -simple lists of strings where each entry is a macro name (without the -leading backslash). - -General macro classes ---------------------- - -font-latex provides keyword lists for different macro classes which are -described in the following table: - -'font-latex-match-function-keywords' - Keywords for macros defining or related to functions, like - '\newcommand'. - Type: '\macro[...]{...}' - Face: 'font-lock-function-name-face' - -'font-latex-match-reference-keywords' - Keywords for macros defining or related to references, like '\ref'. - Type: '\macro[...]{...}' - Face: 'font-lock-constant-face' - -'font-latex-match-textual-keywords' - Keywords for macros specifying textual content, like '\caption'. - Type: '\macro[...]{...}' - Face: 'font-lock-type-face' - -'font-latex-match-variable-keywords' - Keywords for macros defining or related to variables, like - '\setlength'. - Type: '\macro[...]{...}' - Face: 'font-lock-variable-name-face' - -'font-latex-match-warning-keywords' - Keywords for important macros, e.g. affecting line or page break, - like '\clearpage'. - Type: '\macro' - Face: 'font-latex-warning-face' - -Sectioning commands -------------------- - -Sectioning commands are macros like '\chapter' or '\section'. For these -commands there are two fontification schemes which may be selected by -customizing the variable 'font-latex-fontify-sectioning'. - - -- User Option: font-latex-fontify-sectioning - Per default sectioning commands will be shown in a larger, - proportional font, which corresponds to a number for this variable. - The font size varies with the sectioning level, e.g. '\part' - ('font-latex-sectioning-0-face') has a larger font than - '\paragraph' ('font-latex-sectioning-5-face'). Typically, values - from 1.05 to 1.3 for 'font-latex-fontify-sectioning' give best - results, depending on your font setup. If you rather like to use - the base font and a different color, set the variable to the symbol - 'color'. In this case the face 'font-lock-type-face' will be used - to fontify the argument of the sectioning commands. - - You can make font-latex aware of your own sectioning commands be -adding them to the keyword lists: -'font-latex-match-sectioning-0-keywords' -('font-latex-sectioning-0-face') ... -'font-latex-match-sectioning-5-keywords' -('font-latex-sectioning-5-face'). - - Related to sectioning there is special support for slide titles which -may be fontified with the face 'font-latex-slide-title-face'. You can -add macros which should appear in this face by customizing the variable -'font-latex-match-slide-title-keywords'. - -Commands for changing fonts ---------------------------- - -LaTeX provides various macros for changing fonts or font attributes. -For example, you can select an italic font with '\textit{...}' or bold -with '\textbf{...}'. An alternative way to specify these fonts is to -use special macros in TeX groups, like '{\itshape ...}' for italics and -'{\bfseries ...}' for bold. As mentioned above, we call the former -variants commands and the latter declarations. - - Besides the macros for changing fonts provided by LaTeX there is an -infinite number of other macros--either defined by yourself for logical -markup or defined by macro packages--which affect the font in the -typeset text. While LaTeX's built-in macros and macros of packages -known by AUCTeX are already handled by font-latex, different keyword -lists per type style and macro type are provided for entering your own -macros which are listed in the table below. - -'font-latex-match-bold-command-keywords' - Keywords for commands specifying a bold type style. - Face: 'font-latex-bold-face' -'font-latex-match-italic-command-keywords' - Keywords for commands specifying an italic font. - Face: 'font-latex-italic-face' -'font-latex-match-math-command-keywords' - Keywords for commands specifying a math font. - Face: 'font-latex-math-face' -'font-latex-match-type-command-keywords' - Keywords for commands specifying a typewriter font. - Face: 'font-lock-type-face' -'font-latex-match-bold-declaration-keywords' - Keywords for declarations specifying a bold type style. - Face: 'font-latex-bold-face' -'font-latex-match-italic-declaration-keywords' - Keywords for declarations specifying an italic font. - Face: 'font-latex-italic-face' -'font-latex-match-type-declaration-keywords' - Keywords for declarations specifying a typewriter font. - Face: 'font-latex-type-face' - -Deactivating defaults of built-in keyword classes -------------------------------------------------- - -font-latex ships with predefined lists of keywords for the classes -described above. You can disable these defaults per class by -customizing the variable 'font-latex-deactivated-keyword-classes'. This -is a list of strings for keyword classes to be deactivated. Valid -entries are "warning", "variable", "biblatexnoarg", "biblatex", -"reference", "function" , "sectioning-0", "sectioning-1", -"sectioning-2", "sectioning-3", "sectioning-4", "sectioning-5", -"slide-title", "textual", "bold-command", "italic-command", -"math-command", "type-command", "bold-declaration", -"italic-declaration", "type-declaration". - - You can also get rid of certain keywords only. For example if you -want to remove highlighting of footnotes as references you can put the -following stanza into your init file: - - (eval-after-load "font-latex" - '(setq-default - font-latex-match-reference-keywords-local - (remove (assoc-string "footnote" - font-latex-match-reference-keywords-local) - font-latex-match-reference-keywords-local))) - - But note that this means fiddling with font-latex's internals and is -not guaranteed to work in future versions of font-latex. - -User-defined keyword classes ----------------------------- - -In case the customization options explained above do not suffice for -your needs, you can specify your own keyword classes by customizing the -variable 'font-latex-user-keyword-classes'. - - -- User Option: font-latex-user-keyword-classes - Every keyword class consists of four parts, a name, a list of - keywords, a face and a specifier for the type of macros to be - highlighted. - - When adding new entries, you have to use unique values for the - class names, i.e. they must not clash with names of the built-in - keyword classes or other names given by you. Additionally the - names must not contain spaces. - - The list of keywords defines which commands and declarations should - be covered by the keyword class. A keyword can either be a simple - command name omitting the leading backslash or a list consisting of - the command name and a string specifying the sequence of arguments - for the command. - - The face argument can either be an existing face or face attributes - made by you. - - There are three alternatives for the type of keywords--"Command - with arguments", "Declaration inside TeX group" and "Command - without arguments"--which correspond with the macro types explained - above. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Fontification of quotes, Next: Fontification of math, Prev: Fontification of macros, Up: Font Locking - -3.1.2 Fontification of quotes ------------------------------ - -Text in quotation marks is displayed with the face -'font-latex-string-face'. Besides the various forms of opening and -closing double and single quotation marks, so-called guillemets (<<, >>) -can be used for quoting. Because there are two styles of using -them--French style: << text >>; German style: >>text<<--you can -customize the variable 'font-latex-quotes' to tell font-latex which type -you are using if the correct value cannot be derived from document -properties. - - -- User Option: font-latex-quotes - The default value of 'font-latex-quotes' is 'auto' which means that - font-latex will try to derive the correct type of quotation mark - matching from document properties like the language option supplied - to the babel LaTeX package. - - If the automatic detection fails for you and you mostly use one - specific style you can set it to a specific language-dependent - value as well. Set the value to 'german' if you are using >>German - quotes<< and to 'french' if you are using << French quotes >>. - font-latex will recognize the different ways these quotes can be - given in your source code, i.e. ('"<', '">'), ('<<', '>>') and the - respective 8-bit variants. - - If you set 'font-latex-quotes' to nil, quoted content will not be - fontified. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Fontification of math, Next: Verbatim content, Prev: Fontification of quotes, Up: Font Locking - -3.1.3 Fontification of mathematical constructs ----------------------------------------------- - -In LaTeX mathematics can be indicated by a variety of different methods: -toggles (like dollar signs), macros and environments. Math constructs -known by font-latex are displayed with the face 'font-latex-math-face'. -Support for dollar signs and shorthands like '\(...\)' or '\[...\]' is -built-in and not customizable. Support for other math macros and -environments can be adapted by customizing the variables -'font-latex-match-math-command-keywords' and 'texmathp-tex-commands' -respectively. It is no longer recommended to customize -'font-latex-math-environments'. - - To convert your customization in 'font-latex-math-environments' into -'texmathp-tex-commands', please register your own math environments, -together with starred variants if any, as entries of 'env-on' type in -'texmathp-tex-commands', then clear out 'font-latex-math-environments'. -You have to restart Emacs for this new customization to take effect for -fontification. - - In order to make math constructs more readable, font-latex displays -subscript and superscript parts in a smaller font and raised or lowered -respectively. This fontification feature can be controlled with the -variables 'font-latex-fontify-script' and 'font-latex-script-display'. - - -- User Option: font-latex-fontify-script - If non-nil, fontify subscript and superscript strings. Concretely, - this means that the scripts are raised or lowered. - - Another possiblity is setting this variable to the symbol - 'multi-level'. In this case, in a formula x^{y^z}, y is raised - above and smaller than x, and z is raised above and smaller than y. - With many script levels, the text might become too small to be - readable. (See 'font-latex-fontify-script-max-level' below.) - - Lastly, you can set this variable to 'invisible' whose behavior is - like 'multi-level', and in addition the super-/subscript characters - ^ and _ are not displayed. - - -- User Option: font-latex-fontify-script-max-level - Maximum scriptification level for which script faces are applied. - - The faces 'font-latex-superscript-face' and - 'font-latex-subscript-face' define custom ':height' values < 1.0. - Therefore, scripts are displayed with a slightly smaller font than - normal math text. If 'font-latex-fontify-script' is 'multi-level' - or 'invisible', the font size becomes too small to be readable - after a few levels. This option allows to specify the maximum - level after which the size of the script text won’t be shrunken - anymore. - - For example, in the expression x^{y^{z^a_b}}, x has scriptification - level 0, y has level 1, z has level 2, and both a and b have - scriptification level 3. - - If 'font-latex-fontify-script-max-level' was 2, then z, a, and b - would have the same font size. If it was 3 or more, then a and b - were smaller than z just in the same way as z is smaller than y and - y is smaller than x. - - The script characters '^' and '_' themselves are also fontified with -an own face named 'font-latex-script-char-face'. - - -- User Option: font-latex-script-display - Display specification for subscript and superscript content. The - car is used for subscript, the cdr is used for superscript. The - feature is implemented using so-called display properties. For - information on what exactly to specify for the values, see *note - Other Display Specifications: (elisp)Other Display Specs. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Verbatim content, Next: Faces, Prev: Fontification of math, Up: Font Locking - -3.1.4 Verbatim macros and environments --------------------------------------- - -Usually it is not desirable to have content to be typeset verbatim -highlighted according to LaTeX syntax. Therefore this content will be -fontified uniformly with the face 'font-latex-verbatim-face'. - - font-latex differentiates three different types of verbatim -constructs for fontification. Macros with special characters like | as -delimiters, macros with braces, and environments. Which macros and -environments are recognized is controlled by the variables -'LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-delims', -'LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-braces', and 'LaTeX-verbatim-environments' -respectively. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Faces, Next: Known problems, Prev: Verbatim content, Up: Font Locking - -3.1.5 Faces used by font-latex ------------------------------- - -In case you want to change the colors and fonts used by font-latex -please refer to the faces mentioned in the explanations above and use -'M-x customize-face <RET> <face> <RET>'. All faces defined by -font-latex are accessible through a customization group by typing 'M-x -customize-group <RET> font-latex-highlighting-faces <RET>'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Known problems, Prev: Faces, Up: Font Locking - -3.1.6 Known fontification problems ----------------------------------- - -In certain cases the fontification machinery fails to interpret buffer -contents correctly. This can lead to color bleed, i.e. large parts of a -buffer get fontified with an inappropriate face. A typical situation -for this to happen is the use of a dollar sign ('$') in a verbatim macro -or environment. If font-latex is not aware of the verbatim construct, -it assumes the dollar sign to be a toggle for mathematics and fontifies -the following buffer content with the respective face until it finds a -closing dollar sign or till the end of the buffer. - - As a remedy you can make the verbatim construct known to font-latex -(*note Verbatim content::). If this is not possible, you can insert a -commented dollar sign ('%$') at the next suitable end of line as a quick -workaround. In docTeX documents, '^^A$' is also available for similar -purpose. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Folding, Next: Outline, Prev: Font Locking, Up: Display - -3.2 Folding Macros and Environments -=================================== - -A popular complaint about markup languages like TeX and LaTeX is that -there is too much clutter in the source text and that one cannot focus -well on the content. There are macros where you are only interested in -the content they are enclosing, like font specifiers where the content -might already be fontified in a special way by font locking. Or macros -the content of which you only want to see when actually editing it, like -footnotes or citations. Similarly you might find certain environments -or comments distracting when trying to concentrate on the body of your -document. - - With AUCTeX's folding functionality you can collapse those items and -replace them by a fixed string, the content of one of their arguments, -or a mixture of both. If you want to make the original text visible -again in order to view or edit it, move point sideways onto the -placeholder (also called display string) or left-click with the mouse -pointer on it. The macro or environment will unfold automatically, stay -open as long as point is inside of it and collapse again once you move -point out of it. (Note that folding of environments currently does not -work in every AUCTeX mode.) - - In order to use this feature, you have to activate 'TeX-fold-mode' -which will activate the auto-reveal feature and the necessary commands -to hide and show macros and environments. You can activate the mode in -a certain buffer by typing the command 'M-x TeX-fold-mode <RET>' or -using the keyboard shortcut 'C-c C-o C-f'. If you want to use it every -time you edit a LaTeX document, add it to a hook: - - (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook (lambda () - (TeX-fold-mode 1))) - - If it should be activated in all AUCTeX modes, use 'TeX-mode-hook' -instead of 'LaTeX-mode-hook'. - - Once the mode is active there are several commands available to hide -and show macros, environments and comments: - - -- Command: TeX-fold-buffer - ('C-c C-o C-b') Hide all foldable items in the current buffer - according to the setting of 'TeX-fold-type-list'. - - If you want to have this done automatically every time you open a - file, add it to a hook and make sure the function is called after - font locking is set up for the buffer. The following code should - accomplish this: - - (add-hook 'find-file-hook #'TeX-fold-buffer t) - - The command can be used any time to refresh the whole buffer and - fold any new macros and environments which were inserted after the - last invocation of the command. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-type-list - List of symbols determining the item classes to consider for - folding. This can be macros, environments and comments. Per - default only macros and environments are folded. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-force-fontify - In order for all folded content to get the right faces, the whole - buffer has to be fontified before folding is carried out. - 'TeX-fold-buffer' therefore will force fontification of unfontified - regions. As this will prolong the time folding takes, you can - prevent forced fontification by customizing the variable - 'TeX-fold-force-fontify'. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-auto - By default, a macro inserted with 'TeX-insert-macro' ('C-c C-m') - will not be folded. Set this variable to a non-nil value to - aumatically fold macros as soon as they are inserted. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-preserve-comments - By default items found in comments will be folded. If your - comments often contain unfinished code this might lead to problems. - Give this variable a non-nil value and foldable items in your - comments will be left alone. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-unfold-around-mark - When this variable is non-nil and there is an active regione, text - around the mark will be kept unfolded. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-region - ('C-c C-o C-r') Hide all configured macros in the marked region. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-paragraph - ('C-c C-o C-p') Hide all configured macros in the paragraph - containing point. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-macro - ('C-c C-o C-m') Hide the macro on which point currently is located. - If the name of the macro is found in 'TeX-fold-macro-spec-list', - the respective display string will be shown instead. If it is not - found, the name of the macro in sqare brackets or the default - string for unspecified macros - ('TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string') will be shown, depending - on the value of the variable 'TeX-fold-unspec-use-name'. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-env - ('C-c C-o C-e') Hide the environment on which point currently is - located. The behavior regarding the display string is analogous to - 'TeX-fold-macro' and determined by the variables - 'TeX-fold-env-spec-list' and 'TeX-fold-unspec-env-display-string' - respectively. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-math - Hide the math macro on which point currently is located. If the - name of the macro is found in 'TeX-fold-math-spec-list', the - respective display string will be shown instead. If it is not - found, the name of the macro in sqare brackets or the default - string for unspecified macros - ('TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string') will be shown, depending - on the value of the variable 'TeX-fold-unspec-use-name'. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-comment - ('C-c C-o C-c') Hide the comment point is located on. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-clearout-buffer - ('C-c C-o b') Permanently unfold all macros and environments in the - current buffer. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-clearout-region - ('C-c C-o r') Permanently unfold all macros and environments in the - marked region. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-clearout-paragraph - ('C-c C-o p') Permanently unfold all macros and environments in the - paragraph containing point. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-clearout-item - ('C-c C-o i') Permanently show the macro or environment on which - point currently is located. In contrast to temporarily opening the - macro when point is moved sideways onto it, the macro will be - permanently unfolded and will not collapse again once point is - leaving it. - - -- Command: TeX-fold-dwim - ('C-c C-o C-o') Hide or show items according to the current - context. If there is folded content, unfold it. If there is a - marked region, fold all configured content in this region. If - there is no folded content but a macro or environment, fold it. - - In case you want to use a different prefix than 'C-c C-o' for these -commands you can customize the variable 'TeX-fold-command-prefix'. -(Note that this will not change the key binding for activating the -mode.) - - The commands above will only take macros or environments into -consideration which are specified in the variables -'TeX-fold-macro-spec-list' or 'TeX-fold-env-spec-list' respectively. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-macro-spec-list - List of replacement specifiers and macros to fold. The specifier - can be a string, an integer or a function symbol. - - If you specify a string, it will be used as a display replacement - for the whole macro. Numbers in braces, brackets, parens or angle - brackets will be replaced by the respective macro argument. For - example '{1}' will be replaced by the first mandatory argument of - the macro. One can also define alternatives within the specifier - which are used if an argument is not found. Alternatives are - separated by '||'. They are most useful with optional arguments. - As an example, the default specifier for '\item' is '[1]:||*' which - means that if there is an optional argument, its value is shown - followed by a colon. If there is no optional argument, only an - asterisk is used as the display string. - - If you specify a number as the first element, the content of the - respective mandatory argument of a LaTeX macro will be used as the - placeholder. - - If the first element is a function symbol, the function will be - called with all mandatory arguments of the macro and the result of - the function call will be used as a replacement for the macro. - - The placeholder is made by copying the text from the buffer - together with its properties, i.e. its face as well. If - fontification has not happened when this is done (e.g. because of - lazy font locking) the intended fontification will not show up. As - a workaround you can leave Emacs idle a few seconds and wait for - stealth font locking to finish before you fold the buffer. Or you - just re-fold the buffer with 'TeX-fold-buffer' when you notice a - wrong fontification. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-env-spec-list - List of display strings or argument numbers and environments to - fold. Argument numbers refer to the '\begin' statement. That - means if you have e.g. '\begin{tabularx}{\linewidth}{XXX} ... - \end{tabularx}' and specify 3 as the argument number, the resulting - display string will be "XXX". - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-math-spec-list - List of display strings and math macros to fold. - - The variables 'TeX-fold-macro-spec-list', 'TeX-fold-env-spec-list', -and 'TeX-fold-math-spec-list' apply to any AUCTeX mode. If you want to -make settings which are only applied to LaTeX mode, you can use the -mode-specific variables 'LaTeX-fold-macro-spec-list', -'LaTeX-fold-env-spec-list', and 'LaTeX-fold-math-spec-list' - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string - Default display string for macros which are not specified in - 'TeX-fold-macro-spec-list'. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-unspec-env-display-string - Default display string for environments which are not specified in - 'TeX-fold-env-spec-list'. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-unspec-use-name - If non-nil the name of the macro or environment surrounded by - square brackets is used as display string, otherwise the defaults - specified in 'TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string' or - 'TeX-fold-unspec-env-display-string' respectively. - - When you hover with the mouse pointer over folded content, its -original text will be shown in a tooltip or the echo area depending on -Tooltip mode being activate. In order to avoid exorbitantly big -tooltips and to cater for the limited space in the echo area the content -will be cropped after a certain amount of characters defined by the -variable 'TeX-fold-help-echo-max-length'. - - -- User Option: TeX-fold-help-echo-max-length - Maximum length of original text displayed in a tooltip or the echo - area for folded content. Set it to zero in order to disable this - feature. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Outline, Next: Narrowing, Prev: Folding, Up: Display - -3.3 Outlining the Document -========================== - -AUCTeX supports the standard outline minor mode using LaTeX/ConTeXt -sectioning commands as header lines. *Note Outline Mode: (emacs)Outline -Mode. - - You can add your own headings by setting the variable -'TeX-outline-extra'. - - -- Variable: TeX-outline-extra - List of extra TeX outline levels. - - Each element is a list with two entries. The first entry is the - regular expression matching a header, and the second is the level - of the header. A '^' is automatically prepended to the regular - expressions in the list, so they must match text at the beginning - of the line. - - See 'LaTeX-section-list' or 'ConTeXt-INTERFACE-section-list' for - existing header levels. - - The following example add '\item' and '\bibliography' headers, with -'\bibliography' at the same outline level as '\section', and '\item' -being below '\subparagraph'. - - (setq TeX-outline-extra - '(("[ \t]*\\\\\\(bib\\)?item\\b" 7) - ("\\\\bibliography\\b" 2))) - - You may want to check out the unbundled 'out-xtra' package for even -better outline support. It is available from your favorite emacs lisp -archive. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Narrowing, Next: Prettifying, Prev: Outline, Up: Display - -3.4 Narrowing -============= - -Sometimes you want to focus your attention to a limited region of the -code. You can do that by restricting the text addressable by editing -commands and hiding the rest of the buffer with the narrowing functions, -*note (emacs)Narrowing::. In addition, AUCTeX provides a couple of -other commands to narrow the buffer to a group, i.e. a region enclosed -in a pair of curly braces, and to LaTeX environments. - - -- Command: TeX-narrow-to-group - ('C-x n g') Make text outside current group invisible. - - -- Command: LaTeX-narrow-to-environment COUNT - ('C-x n e') Make text outside current environment invisible. With - optional argument COUNT keep visible that number of enclosing - environmens. - - Like other standard narrowing functions, the above commands are -disabled. Attempting to use them asks for confirmation and gives you -the option of enabling them; if you enable the commands, confirmation -will no longer be required for them. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Prettifying, Prev: Narrowing, Up: Display - -3.5 Prettifying -=============== - -Emacs 25 is able to prettify symbols in programming language buffers, -*note (emacs)Misc for Programs::. The canonical example is to display -'(lambda () ...)' as '(λ () ...)' in Lisp buffers. - - AUCTeX can use this feature in order to display certain math macros -and greek letters using their Unicode representation, too. For example, -the TeX code '\alpha \times \beta' will be displayed as 'α × β'. When -point is on one of the characters, it'll be unprettified automatically, -meaning you see the verbatim text again. For this behaviour however you -need to set 'prettify-symbols-unprettify-at-point' to t or 'right-edge' -which will unprettify the symbol when point moves into or near it. - - To enable prettification in AUCTeX, simply add -'prettify-symbols-mode' to 'TeX-mode-hook'. If you enabled -prettification globally with 'global-prettify-symbols-mode', then it's -automatically enabled in AUCTeX, too. - - You can also add custom symbol unicode-character pairs for -prettification by adding to 'tex--prettify-symbols-alist'. Note that -this variable is part of Emacs' stock 'tex-mode.el' and used by that and -AUCTeX. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Processing, Next: Customization, Prev: Display, Up: Top - -4 Starting Processors, Viewers and Other Programs -************************************************* - -The most powerful features of AUCTeX may be those allowing you to run -TeX, LaTeX, ConTeXt and other external commands like BibTeX and -'makeindex' from within Emacs, viewing and printing the results, and -moreover allowing you to _debug_ your documents. - - AUCTeX comes with a special tool bar for TeX and LaTeX which provides -buttons for the most important commands. You can enable or disable it -by customizing the options 'plain-TeX-enable-toolbar' and -'LaTeX-enable-toolbar' in the 'TeX-tool-bar' customization group. You -can also customize the buttons by the options 'TeX-bar-TeX-buttons', -'TeX-bar-TeX-all-button-alists', 'TeX-bar-LaTeX-buttons' and -'TeX-bar-LaTeX-button-alist'. - -* Menu: - -* Commands:: Invoking external commands. -* Viewing:: Invoking external viewers. -* Debugging:: Debugging TeX and LaTeX output. -* Checking:: Checking the document. -* Control:: Controlling the processes. -* Cleaning:: Cleaning intermediate and output files. -* Documentation:: Documentation about macros and packages. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Commands, Next: Viewing, Up: Processing - -4.1 Executing Commands -====================== - -Formatting the document with TeX, LaTeX or ConTeXt, viewing with a -previewer, printing the document, running BibTeX, making an index, or -checking the document with 'lacheck' or 'chktex' all require running an -external command. - -* Menu: - -* Starting a Command:: Starting a Command on a Document or Region -* Selecting a Command:: Selecting and Executing a Command -* Processor Options:: Options for TeX Processors - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Starting a Command, Next: Selecting a Command, Up: Commands - -4.1.1 Starting a Command on a Document or Region ------------------------------------------------- - -There are two ways to run an external command, you can either run it on -the current document with 'TeX-command-master', or on the current region -with 'TeX-command-region'. A special case of running TeX on a region is -'TeX-command-buffer' which differs from 'TeX-command-master' if the -current buffer is not its own master file. - - -- Command: TeX-command-master - ('C-c C-c') Query the user for a command, and run it on the master - file associated with the current buffer. The name of the master - file is controlled by the variable 'TeX-master'. The available - commands are controlled by the variable 'TeX-command-list'. - - -- Command: TeX-command-region - ('C-c C-r') Query the user for a command, and run it on the - contents of the selected region. The region contents are written - into the region file, after extracting the header and trailer from - the master file. If mark is inactive (which can happen with - Transient Mark mode), use the old region. See also the command - 'TeX-pin-region' about how to fix a region. - - The name of the region file is controlled by the variable - 'TeX-region'. The name of the master file is controlled by the - variable 'TeX-master'. The header is all text up to the line - matching the regular expression 'TeX-header-end'. The trailer is - all text from the line matching the regular expression - 'TeX-trailer-start'. The available commands are controlled by the - variable 'TeX-command-list'. - - -- Command: TeX-command-buffer - ('C-c C-b') Query the user for a command, and apply it to the - contents of the current buffer. The buffer contents are written - into the region file, after extracting the header and trailer from - the master file. The command is then actually run on the region - file. See above for details. - - -- Command: LaTeX-command-section - ('C-c C-z') Query the user for a command, and apply it to the - current section (or part, chapter, subsection, paragraph, or - subparagraph). What makes the current section is determined by - 'LaTeX-command-section-level' which can be enlarged/shrunken using - 'LaTeX-command-section-change-level' ('C-c M-z'). The given - numeric prefix arg is added to the current value of - 'LaTeX-command-section-level'. By default, - 'LaTeX-command-section-level' is initialized with the current - document's 'LaTeX-largest-level'. The buffer contents are written - into the region file, after extracting the header and trailer from - the master file. The command is then actually run on the region - file. See 'TeX-command-region' for details. - - It is also possible to compile automatically the whole document until -it is ready with a single command: 'TeX-command-run-all'. - - -- Command: TeX-command-run-all - ('C-c C-a') Compile the current document until an error occurs or - it is finished. If compilation finishes successfully, run the - viewer at the end. - - Here are some relevant variables. - - -- User Option: TeX-region - The name of the file for temporarily storing the text when - formatting the current region. - - -- User Option: TeX-header-end - A regular expression matching the end of the header. By default, - this is '\begin{document}' in LaTeX mode and '%**end of header' in - plain TeX mode. - - -- User Option: TeX-trailer-start - A regular expression matching the start of the trailer. By - default, this is '\end{document}' in LaTeX mode and '\bye' in plain - TeX mode. - - If you want to change the values of 'TeX-header-end' and -'TeX-trailer-start' you can do this for all files by setting the -variables in a mode hook or per file by specifying them as file -variables (*note (emacs)File Variables::). - - -- Command: TeX-pin-region - ('C-c C-t C-r') If you don't have a mode like Transient Mark mode - active, where marks get disabled automatically, the region would - need to get properly set before each call to 'TeX-command-region'. - If you fix the current region with 'C-c C-t C-r', then it will get - used for more commands even though mark and point may change. An - explicitly activated mark, however, will always define a new region - when calling 'TeX-command-region'. - - If the last process you started was on the region, the commands -described in *note Debugging:: and *note Control:: will work on that -process, otherwise they will work on the process associated with the -current document. - - Don't run more than one process at the same time. AUCTeX doesn't -support simultaneous typeset including region typeset. Wait for the -previous process to finish before you start a new process, in particular -when you are editing multiple documents in parallel. This limitation -applies for preview by preview-latex as well. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Selecting a Command, Next: Processor Options, Prev: Starting a Command, Up: Commands - -4.1.2 Selecting and Executing a Command ---------------------------------------- - -Once you started the command selection with 'C-c C-c', 'C-c C-r' or 'C-c -C-b' you will be prompted for the type of command. AUCTeX will try to -guess which command is appropriate in the given situation and propose it -as default. Usually this is a processor like 'TeX' or 'LaTeX' if the -document was changed or a viewer if the document was just typeset. -Other commands can be selected in the minibuffer with completion support -by typing <TAB>. - - The available commands are defined by the variable -'TeX-command-list'. Per default it includes commands for typesetting -the document (e.g. 'LaTeX'), for viewing the output ('View'), for -printing ('Print'), for generating an index ('Index') or for spell -checking ('Spell') to name but a few. You can also add your own -commands by adding entries to 'TeX-command-list'. Refer to its doc -string for information about its syntax. You might also want to look at -'TeX-expand-list' to learn about the expanders you can use in -'TeX-command-list'. - - Note that the default of the variable occasionally changes. -Therefore it is advisable to add to the list rather than overwriting it. -You can do this with a call to 'add-to-list' in your init file. For -example, if you wanted to add a command for running a program called -'foo' on the master or region file, you could do this with the following -form. - - (eval-after-load "tex" - '(add-to-list 'TeX-command-list - '("Foo" "foo %s" TeX-run-command t t :help "Run foo") - t)) - - As mentioned before, AUCTeX will try to guess what command you want -to invoke. If you want to use another command than 'TeX', 'LaTeX' or -whatever processor AUCTeX thinks is appropriate for the current mode, -set the variable 'TeX-command-default'. You can do this for all files -by setting it in a mode hook or per file by specifying it as a file -variable (*note (emacs)File Variables::). - - -- User Option: TeX-command-default - The default command to run in this buffer. Must be an entry in - 'TeX-command-list'. - - In case you use biblatex in a document, when automatic parsing is -enabled AUCTeX checks the value of 'backend' option given to biblatex at -load time to decide whether to use BibTeX or Biber for bibliography -processing. Should AUCTeX fail to detect the right backend, you can use -the file local 'LaTeX-biblatex-use-Biber' variable. - -- Variable: LaTeX-biblatex-use-Biber - If this boolean variable is set as file local, it tells to AUCTeX - whether to use Biber with biblatex. In this case, the - autodetection of the biblatex backend will be overridden. You may - want to set locally this variable if automatic parsing is not - enabled. - - After confirming a command to execute, AUCTeX will try to save any -buffers related to the document, and check if the document needs to be -reformatted. If the variable 'TeX-save-query' is non-nil, AUCTeX will -query before saving each file. By default AUCTeX will check emacs -buffers associated with files in the current directory, in one of the -'TeX-macro-private' directories, and in the 'TeX-macro-global' -directories. You can change this by setting the variable -'TeX-check-path'. - - -- User Option: TeX-check-path - Directory path to search for dependencies. - - If nil, just check the current file. Used when checking if any - files have changed. - - When performing spell checking on a document or a region (invoked -through AUCTeX's 'Spell' command or 'M-x ispell <RET>'), you want the -spell checking program to skip certain macro arguments and environments, -most notably the arguments of referencing macros and the contents of -verbatim environments. The skipped parts are controlled by variable -'ispell-tex-skip-alists' provided by 'ispell.el'. AUCTeX has a library -which can be added to this variable depending on the value of -'TeX-ispell-extend-skip-list' which is set to 't' by default. - - -- User Option: TeX-ispell-extend-skip-list - This boolean option controls whether AUCTeX activates its extension - for skipping certain macro arguments and environments when spell - checking. - - When non-'nil', AUCTeX loads the file 'tex-ispell.el' and adds its - content to 'ispell-tex-skip-alists'. This library can and will - never be complete, but the interface can be used to add selected - and private macro names within your init file or on a file local - basis. - - 'ispell-tex-skip-alists' has the following structure: - (defvar ispell-tex-skip-alists - '((;; First list - ("\\\\addcontentsline" ispell-tex-arg-end 2) - ("\\\\\\([aA]lph\\|arabic\\)" ispell-tex-arg-end) - ("\\\\makebox" ispell-tex-arg-end 0) - ("\\\\documentclass" . "\\\\begin{document}")) - (;; Second list - ("\\(figure\\|table\\)\\*?" ispell-tex-arg-end 0) - ("list" ispell-tex-arg-end 2) - ("verbatim\\*?" . "\\\\end{verbatim\\*?}"))) - "Lists of regions to be skipped in TeX mode. - First list is used raw. - Second list has key placed inside \\begin{}.") - Each item is an alist and the structure of it is described in - 'ispell-skip-region-alist': - (defvar ispell-skip-region-alist - '((...)) - "Alist expressing beginning and end of regions not to spell check. - The alist key must be a regular expression. - Valid forms include: - (KEY) - just skip the key. - (KEY . REGEXP) - skip to the end of REGEXP. - REGEXP may be string or symbol. - (KEY REGEXP) - skip to end of REGEXP. REGEXP must be a string. - (KEY FUNCTION ARGS) - FUNCTION called with ARGS - returns end of region.") - - Let's go through the first list of 'ispell-tex-skip-alists' line by - line: - ("\\\\addcontentsline" ispell-tex-arg-end 2) - 'KEY' is the string '"\\\\addcontentsline"', 'FUNCTION' is - 'ispell-tex-arg-end' called with 'ARGS', here '2'. - 'ispell-tex-arg-end' is a function provided by 'ispell.el' which - skips as many subsequent optional arguments in square brackets as - it sees and then skips 'ARGS' number of mandatory arguments in - braces. Omitting 'ARGS' means skip '1' mandatory argument. In - practice, when you have something like this in your document: - \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{Some text} - The first two arguments are left out and 'Some text' will be spell - checked. For the next line - ("\\\\\\([aA]lph\\|arabic\\)" ispell-tex-arg-end) - the name of the counter as argument is skipped. Next line is - ("\\\\makebox" ispell-tex-arg-end 0) - where only optional arguments are skipped, the first mandatory - argument is checked, e.g. - \makebox[0pt][l]{Some text} - Finally, the next line - ("\\\\documentclass" . "\\\\begin{document}")) - ensures that the entire preamble of a document is discarded. - Second list works the same; it is more convenient for environments - since 'KEY' is wrapped inside '\begin{}'. - - AUCTeX provides two functions to add items to car and cdr of - 'ispell-tex-arg-end', namely 'TeX-ispell-skip-setcar' and - 'TeX-ispell-skip-setcdr'. The argument of these functions is - exactly as in 'ispell-tex-skip-alists'. Additions can be done via - init file, e.g.: - (eval-after-load "tex-ispell" - '(progn - (TeX-ispell-skip-setcar - '(("\\\\mymacro" ispell-tex-arg-end))) - (TeX-ispell-skip-setcdr - '(("myverbatim" . "\\\\end{myverbatim}"))))) - - Another possibility is to use file local additions at the end of - your TeX file, e.g.: - %%% Local Variables: - %%% mode: latex - %%% TeX-master: t - %%% eval: (TeX-ispell-skip-setcar '(("\\\\mymacro" . "{[-0-9]+}"))) - %%% End: - - Finally, AUCTeX provides a function called 'TeX-ispell-tex-arg-end' - which sees more arguments than 'ispell-tex-arg-end'. Refer to its - doc string for more information. - - AUCTeX also provides a facility to skip the argument of in-line -verbatim macros like '\Verb' from 'fancyvrb.sty' or '\mintinline' from -'minted.sty'. Characters delimiting the verbatim text are stored in -'TeX-ispell-verb-delimiters'. - - -- User Option: TeX-ispell-verb-delimiters - String with delimiters recognized for in-line verbatim macros. - This variable is initialized to '!|#~"*/+^-'. Since this string is - used to build a character alternative inside a regular expression, - special characters '^' and '-' should come last. Other characters - like opening brace '{', asterisk '*' or at sign '@' should be - avoided as they are not recognized by 'font-latex.el'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Processor Options, Prev: Selecting a Command, Up: Commands - -4.1.3 Options for TeX Processors --------------------------------- - -There are some options you can customize affecting which processors are -invoked or the way this is done and which output they produce as a -result. These options control if DVI or PDF output should be produced, -if TeX should be started in interactive or nonstop mode, if source -specials or a SyncTeX file should be produced for making inverse and -forward search possible or which TeX engine should be used instead of -regular TeX, like PDFTeX, Omega or XeTeX, and the style error messages -are printed with. - - -- Command: TeX-PDF-mode - ('C-c C-t C-p') This command toggles the PDF mode of AUCTeX, a - buffer-local minor mode which is enabled by default. You can - customize 'TeX-PDF-mode' to give it a different default or set it - as a file local variable on a per-document basis. This option - usually results in calling either PDFTeX or ordinary TeX. - - -- User Option: TeX-DVI-via-PDFTeX - If this is set, DVI will also be produced by calling PDFTeX, - setting '\pdfoutput=0'. This makes it possible to use PDFTeX - features like character protrusion even when producing DVI files. - Contemporary TeX distributions do this anyway, so that you need not - enable the option within AUCTeX. - - -- Command: TeX-interactive-mode - ('C-c C-t C-i') This command toggles the interactive mode of - AUCTeX, a global minor mode. You can customize - 'TeX-interactive-mode' to give it a different default. In - interactive mode, TeX will pause with an error prompt when errors - are encountered and wait for the user to type something. - - -- Command: TeX-source-correlate-mode - ('C-c C-t C-s') Toggles support for forward and inverse search. - Forward search refers to jumping to the place in the previewed - document corresponding to where point is located in the document - source and inverse search to the other way round. *Note I/O - Correlation::. - - You can permanently activate 'TeX-source-correlate-mode' by - customizing the variable 'TeX-source-correlate-mode'. There is a - bunch of customization options for the mode, use 'M-x - customize-group <RET> TeX-view <RET>' to find out more. - - AUCTeX is aware of three different means to do I/O correlation: - source specials (only DVI output), the pdfsync LaTeX package (only - PDF output) and SyncTeX. The choice between source specials and - SyncTeX can be controlled with the variable - 'TeX-source-correlate-method'. - - Should you use source specials it has to be stressed _very_ - strongly however, that source specials can cause differences in - page breaks and spacing, can seriously interfere with various - packages and should thus _never_ be used for the final version of a - document. In particular, fine-tuning the page breaks should be - done with source specials switched off. - - Sometimes you are requested, by journal rules or packages, to compile -the document into DVI output. Thus, if you want a PDF document in the -end you can either use XeTeX engine, see below for information about how -to set engines, or compile the document with 'tex' and then convert to -PDF with 'dvips'-'ps2pdf' before viewing it. In addition, current -Japanese TeX engines cannot generate PDF directly so they rely on -DVI-to-PDF converters. Usually 'dvipdfmx' command is used for this -purpose. You can use the 'TeX-PDF-from-DVI' variable to let AUCTeX know -you want to generate the final PDF by converting a DVI file. - - -- User Option: TeX-PDF-from-DVI - This option controls if and how to produce a PDF file by converting - a DVI file. - - When 'TeX-PDF-mode' is non-nil, if 'TeX-PDF-from-DVI' is non-nil - too the document is compiled to DVI instead of PDF. When the - document is ready, 'C-c C-c' will suggest to run the converter to - PDF or an intermediate format. - - If non-nil, 'TeX-PDF-from-DVI' should be the name of the command in - 'TeX-command-list', as a string, used to convert the DVI file to - PDF or to an intermediate format. Values currently supported are: - * '"Dvips"': the DVI file is converted to PS with 'dvips'. - After successfully running it, 'ps2pdf' will be the default - command to convert the PS file to PDF. - * '"Dvipdfmx"': the DVI file is converted to PDF with - 'dvipdfmx'. - (case is significant; note the uppercase 'D' in both strings) When - the PDF file is finally ready, the next suggested command will be - 'View' to open the viewer. - - This option can also be set as a file local variable, in order to - use this conversion on a per-document basis. - - Recall the whole sequence of 'C-c C-c' commands can be replaced by - the single 'C-c C-a'. - - AUCTeX also allows you to easily select different TeX engines for -processing, either by using the entries in the 'TeXing Options' submenu -below the 'Command' menu or by calling the function 'TeX-engine-set'. -These eventually set the variable 'TeX-engine' which you can also modify -directly. - - -- User Option: TeX-engine - This variable allows you to choose which TeX engine should be used - for typesetting the document, i.e. the executables which will be - used when you invoke the 'TeX' or 'LaTeX' commands. The value - should be one of the symbols defined in 'TeX-engine-alist-builtin' - or 'TeX-engine-alist'. The symbols 'default', 'xetex', 'luatex' - and 'omega' are available from the built-in list. - - Note that 'TeX-engine' is buffer-local, so setting the variable -directly or via the above mentioned menu or function will not take -effect in other buffers. If you want to activate an engine for all -AUCTeX modes, set 'TeX-engine' in your init file, e.g. by using 'M-x -customize-option <RET>'. If you want to activate it for a certain -AUCTeX mode only, set the variable in the respective mode hook. If you -want to activate it for certain files, set it through file variables -(*note (emacs)File Variables::). - - Should you need to change the executable names related to the -different engine settings, there are some variables you can tweak. -Those are 'TeX-command', 'LaTeX-command', 'TeX-Omega-command', -'LaTeX-Omega-command', 'ConTeXt-engine' and 'ConTeXt-Omega-engine'. The -rest of the executables is defined directly in -'TeX-engine-alist-builtin'. If you want to override an entry from that, -add an entry to 'TeX-engine-alist' that starts with the same symbol as -that the entry in the built-in list and specify the executables you want -to use instead. You can also add entries to 'TeX-engine-alist' in order -to add support for engines not covered per default. - - -- User Option: TeX-engine-alist - Alist of TeX engines and associated commands. Each entry is a list - with a maximum of five elements. The first element is a symbol - used to identify the engine. The second is a string describing the - engine. The third is the command to be used for plain TeX. The - fourth is the command to be used for LaTeX. The fifth is the - command to be used for the '--engine' parameter of ConTeXt's - 'texexec' program. Each command can either be a variable or a - string. An empty string or nil means there is no command - available. - - In some systems, Emacs cannot inherit the 'PATH' environment variable -from the shell and thus AUCTeX may not be able to run TeX commands. -Before running them, AUCTeX checks if it is able to find those commands -and will warn you in case it fails. You can skip this test by changing -the option 'TeX-check-TeX'. - - -- User Option: TeX-check-TeX - If non-nil, AUCTeX will check if it is able to find a working TeX - distribution before running TeX, LaTeX, ConTeXt, etc. It actually - checks if can run 'TeX-command' command or the shell returns a - command not found error. The error code returned by the shell in - this case can be set in 'TeX-check-TeX-command-not-found' option. - - Some LaTeX packages requires the document to be compiled with a -specific engine. Notable examples are 'fontspec' and 'polyglossia' -packages, which require LuaTeX and XeTeX engines. If you try to compile -a document which loads one of such packages and the set engine is not -one of those allowed you will be asked to select a different engine -before running the LaTeX command. If you do not want to be warned by -AUCTeX in these cases, customize the option 'TeX-check-engine'. - - -- User Option: TeX-check-engine - This boolean option controls whether AUCTeX should check the - correct engine has been set before running LaTeX commands. - - As shown above, AUCTeX handles in a special way most of the main -options that can be given to the TeX processors. When you need to pass -to the TeX processor arbitrary options not handled by AUCTeX, you can -use the file local variable 'TeX-command-extra-options'. - -- User Option: TeX-command-extra-options - String with the extra options to be given to the TeX processor. - For example, if you need to enable the shell escape feature to - compile a document, add the following line to the list of local - variables of the source file: - %%% TeX-command-extra-options: "-shell-escape" - By default this option is not safe as a file-local variable because - a specially crafted document compiled with shell escape enabled can - be used for malicious purposes. - - You can customize AUCTeX to show the processor output as it is -produced. - - -- User Option: TeX-show-compilation - If non-nil, the output of TeX compilation is shown in another - window. - - You can instruct TeX to print error messages in the form -'file:line:error' which is similar to the way many compilers format -them. - - -- User Option: TeX-file-line-error - If non-nil, TeX will produce 'file:line:error' style error - messages. - - ConTeXt users can choose between Mark II and Mark IV versions. This -is controlled by 'ConTeXt-Mark-version' option. - - -- User Option: ConTeXt-Mark-version - This variables specifies which version of Mark should be used. - Values currently supported are '"II"', the default, and '"IV"'. It - can be set globally using customization interface or on a per-file - basis, by specifying it as a file variable. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Viewing, Next: Debugging, Prev: Commands, Up: Processing - -4.2 Viewing the Formatted Output -================================ - -AUCTeX allows you to start external programs for previewing the -formatted output of your document. - -* Menu: - -* Starting Viewers:: Starting viewers -* I/O Correlation:: Forward and inverse search - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Starting Viewers, Next: I/O Correlation, Up: Viewing - -4.2.1 Starting Viewers ----------------------- - -Viewers are normally invoked by pressing 'C-c C-c' once the document is -formatted, which will propose the 'View' command, or by activating the -respective entry in the Command menu. Alternatively you can type 'C-c -C-v' which calls the function 'TeX-view'. - - -- Command: TeX-view - ('C-c C-v') Start a viewer without confirmation. The viewer is - started either on a region or the master file, depending on the - last command issued. This is especially useful for jumping to the - location corresponding to point in the viewer when using - 'TeX-source-correlate-mode'. - - AUCTeX will try to guess which type of viewer (DVI, PostScript or -PDF) has to be used and what options are to be passed over to it. This -decision is based on the output files present in the working directory -as well as the class and style options used in the document. For -example, if there is a DVI file in your working directory, a DVI viewer -will be invoked. In case of a PDF file it will be a PDF viewer. If you -specified a special paper format like 'a5paper' or use the 'landscape' -option, this will be passed to the viewer by the appropriate options. -Especially some DVI viewers depend on this kind of information in order -to display your document correctly. In case you are using 'pstricks' or -'psfrag' in your document, a DVI viewer cannot display the contents -correctly and a PostScript viewer will be invoked instead. - - The association between the tests for the conditions mentioned above -and the viewers is made in the variable 'TeX-view-program-selection'. -Therefore this variable is the starting point for customization if you -want to use other viewers than the ones suggested by default. - - -- User Option: TeX-view-program-selection - This is a list of predicates and viewers which is evaluated from - front to back in order to find out which viewer to call under the - given conditions. In the first element of each list item you can - reference one or more predicates defined in - 'TeX-view-predicate-list' or 'TeX-view-predicate-list-builtin'. In - the second element you can reference a viewer defined in - 'TeX-view-program-list' or 'TeX-view-program-list-builtin'. The - viewer of the first item with a positively evaluated predicate is - selected. - - So 'TeX-view-program-selection' only contains references to the -actual implementations of predicates and viewer commands respectively -which can be found elsewhere. AUCTeX comes with a set of preconfigured -predicates and viewer commands which are stored in the variables -'TeX-view-predicate-list-builtin' and 'TeX-view-program-list-builtin' -respectively. If you are not satisfied with those and want to overwrite -one of them or add your own definitions, you can do so via the variables -'TeX-view-predicate-list' and 'TeX-view-program-list'. - - -- User Option: TeX-view-predicate-list - This is a list of predicates for viewer selection and invocation. - The first element of each list item is a symbol and the second - element a Lisp form to be evaluated. The form should return nil if - the predicate is not fulfilled. - - A built-in predicate from 'TeX-view-predicate-list-builtin' can be - overwritten by defining a new predicate with the same symbol. - - -- User Option: TeX-view-program-list - This is a list of viewer specifications each consisting of a - symbolic name and either a command line or a function to be invoked - when the viewer is called. If a command line is used, parts of it - can be conditionalized by prefixing them with predicates from - 'TeX-view-predicate-list' or 'TeX-view-predicate-list-builtin'. - (See the doc string for the exact format to use.) The command line - can also contain placeholders as defined in 'TeX-expand-list' and - 'TeX-expand-list-builtin' which are expanded before the viewer is - called. - - The third element of each item is a string, or a list of strings, - with the name of the executable, or executables, needed to open the - output file in the viewer. Placeholders defined in - 'TeX-expand-list' and 'TeX-expand-list-builtin' can be used here. - This element is optional and is used to check whether the viewer is - actually available on the system. - - A built-in viewer spec from 'TeX-view-program-list-builtin' can be - overwritten by defining a new viewer spec with the same name. - - After the viewer is called via either the 'View' command or the key -stroke 'C-c C-v', the window system focus goes and stays on the viewer. -If you prefer that the focus is pulled back to Emacs immediately after -that and you are using evince-compatible viewer, customize the option -'TeX-view-enince-keep-focus'. - - -- User Option: TeX-view-evince-keep-focus - When this option is non-nil and the viewer is compatible with - evince, the focus is pulled back to Emacs immediately after the - viewer is invoked or refreshed from within AUCTeX. - - Note that the viewer selection and invocation as described above will -only work if certain default settings in AUCTeX are intact. For one, -the whole viewer selection machinery will only be triggered if there is -no '%V' expander in 'TeX-expand-list'. So if you have trouble with the -viewer invocation you might check if there is an older customization of -the variable in place. In addition, the use of a function in -'TeX-view-program-list' only works if the 'View' command in -'TeX-command-list' makes use of the hook 'TeX-run-discard-or-function'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: I/O Correlation, Prev: Starting Viewers, Up: Viewing - -4.2.2 Forward and Inverse Search --------------------------------- - -Forward and inverse search refer to the correlation between the document -source in the editor and the typeset document in the viewer. Forward -search allows you to jump to the place in the previewed document -corresponding to a certain line in the document source and inverse -search vice versa. - - AUCTeX supports three methods for forward and inverse search: source -specials (only DVI output), the pdfsync LaTeX package (only PDF output) -and SyncTeX (any type of output). If you want to make use of forward -and inverse searching with source specials or SyncTeX, switch on -'TeX-source-correlate-mode'. *Note Processor Options::, on how to do -that. The use of the pdfsync package is detected automatically if -document parsing is enabled. Customize the variable -'TeX-source-correlate-method' to select the method to use. - - -- User Option: TeX-source-correlate-method - Method to use for enabling forward and inverse search. This can be - 'source-specials' if source specials should be used, 'synctex' if - SyncTeX should be used, or 'auto' if AUCTeX should decide. - - When the variable is set to 'auto', AUCTeX will always use SyncTeX - if your 'latex' processor supports it, source specials otherwise. - You must make sure your viewer supports the same method. - - It is also possible to specify a different method depending on the - output, either DVI or PDF, by setting the variable to an alist of - the kind - ((dvi . '<source-specials or synctex>') - (pdf . '<source-specials or synctex>')) - in which the CDR of each entry is a symbol specifying the method to - be used in the corresponding mode. The default value of the - variable is - ((dvi . source-specials) - (pdf . synctex)) - which is compatible with the majority of viewers. - - Forward search happens automatically upon calling the viewer, e.g. by -typing 'C-c C-v' ('TeX-view'). This will open the viewer or bring it to -front and display the output page corresponding to the position of point -in the source file. AUCTeX will automatically pass the necessary -command line options to the viewer for this to happen. - - You can also make special mouse event do forward search at the -clicked position. Use 'TeX-source-correlate-map'(1) and -'TeX-view-mouse' like this: - (eval-after-load "tex" - '(define-key TeX-source-correlate-map [C-down-mouse-1] - #'TeX-view-mouse)) - This example binds 'C-down-mouse-1', which usually opens a concise -menu to select buffer, to the command to do forward search. - - Upon opening the viewer you will be asked if you want to start a -server process (Gnuserv or Emacs server) which is necessary for inverse -search. This happens only if there is no server running already. You -can customize the variable 'TeX-source-correlate-start-server' to -inhibit the question and always or never start the server respectively. - - -- User Option: TeX-source-correlate-start-server - If 'TeX-source-correlate-mode' is active and a viewer is invoked, - the default behavior is to ask if a server process should be - started. Set this variable to 't' if the question should be - inhibited and the server should always be started. Set it to 'nil' - if the server should never be started. Inverse search will not be - available in the latter case. - - Inverse search, i.e. jumping to the part of your document source in -Emacs corresponding to a certain position in the viewer, is triggered -from the viewer, typically by a mouse click. Refer to the documentation -of your viewer to find out how it has to be configured and what you have -to do exactly. In xdvi you normally have to use 'C-down-mouse-1'. - - Note that inverse search with the Evince PDF viewer or its MATE fork -Atril might fail in raising the Emacs frame after updating point in your -document's buffer. There is simply no way to raise the Emacs frame -reliably accross different operating systems and different window -managers with their different focus stealing policies. If the Emacs -frame is not raised after performing an inverse search from Evince or -Atril, you can customize the following option. - - -- User Option: TeX-raise-frame-function - A function that will be called after performing an inverse search - from Evince or Atril in order to raise the current Emacs frame. - - If your Emacs frame is already raised in that situation, just leave - this variable set to its default value 'raise-frame'. Otherwise, - here are some alternative settings that work for some users. - - ;; Alternative 1: For some users, `x-focus-frame' works. - (setq TeX-raise-frame-function #'x-focus-frame) - - ;; Alternative 2: Under GNOME 3.20 (and probably others), it - ;; seems some focus stealing prevention policy prohibits that - ;; some window gets the focus immediately after the user has - ;; clicked in some other window. Here waiting a bit before - ;; issuing the request seems to work. - (setq TeX-raise-frame-function - (lambda () - (run-at-time 0.5 nil #'x-focus-frame))) - - ;; Alternative 3: Use the external wmctrl tool in order to - ;; force Emacs into the focus. - (setq TeX-raise-frame-function - (lambda () - (call-process - "wmctrl" nil nil nil "-i" "-R" - (frame-parameter (selected-frame) 'outer-window-id)))) - - ---------- Footnotes ---------- - - (1) The keymap name is 'TeX-source-correlate-map', not -'TeX-source-correlate-mode-map'. Actually, this keymap isn't -implemented as minor mode map of 'TeX-source-correlate-mode', in order -that its bindings don't affect buffers outside of AUCTeX. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Debugging, Next: Checking, Prev: Viewing, Up: Processing - -4.3 Catching the errors -======================= - -Once you've formatted your document you may 'debug' it, i.e. browse -through the errors (La)TeX reported. You may also have a look at a -nicely formatted list of all errors and warnings reported by the -compiler. - - -- Command: TeX-next-error ARG REPARSE - ('C-c `') Go to the next error reported by TeX. The view will be - split in two, with the cursor placed as close as possible to the - error in the top view. In the bottom view, the error message will - be displayed along with some explanatory text. - - An optional numeric ARG, positive or negative, specifies how many - error messages to move. A negative ARG means to move back to - previous error messages, see also 'TeX-previous-error'. - - The optional REPARSE argument makes AUCTeX reparse the error - message buffer and start the debugging from the first error. This - can also be achieved by calling the function with a prefix argument - ('C-u'). - - -- Command: TeX-previous-error ARG - ('M-g p') Go to the previous error reported by TeX. An optional - numeric ARG specifies how many error messages to move backward. - This is like calling 'TeX-next-error' with a negative argument. - - The command 'TeX-previous-error' works only if AUCTeX can parse the -whole TeX log buffer. This is controlled by the 'TeX-parse-all-errors' -variable. - - -- User Option: TeX-parse-all-errors - If t, AUCTeX automatically parses the whole output log buffer right - after running a TeX command, in order to collect all warnings and - errors. This makes it possible to navigate back and forth between - the error messages using 'TeX-next-error' and 'TeX-previous-error'. - This is the default. If nil, AUCTeX does not parse the whole - output log buffer and 'TeX-previous-error' cannot be used. - - As default, AUCTeX will display a special help buffer containing the -error reported by TeX along with the documentation. There is however an -'expert' option, which allows you to display the real TeX output. - - -- User Option: TeX-display-help - If t AUCTeX will automatically display a help text whenever an - error is encountered using 'TeX-next-error' ('C-c `'). If nil a - terse information about the error is displayed in the echo area. - If 'expert' AUCTeX will display the output buffer with the raw TeX - output. - -* Menu: - -* Ignoring warnings:: Controlling warnings to be reported -* Error overview:: List of all errors and warnings - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Ignoring warnings, Next: Error overview, Up: Debugging - -4.3.1 Controlling warnings to be reported ------------------------------------------ - -Normally AUCTeX will only report real errors, but you may as well ask it -to report 'bad boxes' and warnings as well. - - -- Command: TeX-toggle-debug-bad-boxes - ('C-c C-t C-b') Toggle whether AUCTeX should stop at bad boxes - (i.e. overfull and underfull boxes) as well as normal errors. The - boolean option 'TeX-debug-bad-boxes' is set accordingly. - - -- Command: TeX-toggle-debug-warnings - ('C-c C-t C-w') Toggle whether AUCTeX should stop at warnings as - well as normal errors. The boolean option 'TeX-debug-warnings' is - set accordingly. - - While many users desire to have warnings reported after compilation, -there are certain warnings that are considered unimportant and users -want to ignore them. For a more fine-grained control of what kinds of -warnings should be shown after compilation, AUCTeX provides other -options. - - -- User Option: TeX-ignore-warnings - Controls which warnings are to be ignored. - - It can be a regexp matching the message of the warnings to be - ignored. - - More advanced users can set also this option to a symbol with the - name of a custom function taking as arguments all the information - of the warning listed in 'TeX-error-list' variable, except the last - one about whether to ignore the warning. See the code of - 'TeX-warning' function and the documentation of 'TeX-error-list' - for more details. - - -- Command: TeX-toggle-suppress-ignored-warnings - ('C-c C-t C-x') Toggle whether AUCTeX should actually hide the - ignored warnings specified with 'TeX-ignore-warnings'. The boolean - option 'TeX-suppress-ignored-warnings' is set accordingly. If this - is nil, all warnings are shown, even those matched by - 'TeX-ignore-warnings', otherwise these are hidden. - - Note that 'TeX-debug-warnings' takes the precedence: if it is nil, - all warnings are hidden in any case. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Error overview, Prev: Ignoring warnings, Up: Debugging - -4.3.2 List of all errors and warnings -------------------------------------- - -When the option 'TeX-parse-all-errors' is non-nil, you will be also able -to open an overview of all errors and warnings reported by the TeX -compiler. - - -- Command: TeX-error-overview - Show an overview of the errors and warnings occurred in the last - TeX run. - - In this window you can visit the error on which point is by - pressing <RET>, and visit the next or previous issue by pressing - <n> or <p> respectively. A prefix argument to these keys specifies - how many errors to move forward or backward. You can visit an - error also by clicking on its message. Jump to error point in the - source code with <j>, and use <l> see the error in the log buffer. - In addition, you can toggle visibility of bad boxes, generic - warnings, and ignored warnings with <b>, <w>, and <x>, respectively - (see *note Ignoring warnings:: for details). Press <q> to quit the - overview. - - -- User Option: TeX-error-overview-open-after-TeX-run - When this boolean variable is non-nil, the error overview will be - automatically opened after running TeX if there are errors or - warnings to show. - - The error overview is opened in a new window of the current frame by -default, but you can change this behavior by customizing the option -'TeX-error-overview-setup'. - - -- User Option: TeX-error-overview-setup - Controls the frame setup of the error overview. The possible value - is: 'separate-frame'; with a nil value the current frame is used - instead. - - The parameters of the separate frame can be set with the - 'TeX-error-overview-frame-parameters' option. - - If the display does not support multi frame, the current frame will - be used regardless of the value of this variable. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Checking, Next: Control, Prev: Debugging, Up: Processing - -4.4 Checking for problems -========================= - -Running TeX or LaTeX will only find regular errors in the document, not -examples of bad style. Furthermore, description of the errors may often -be confusing. The utilities 'lacheck' and 'chktex' can be used to find -style errors, such as forgetting to escape the space after an -abbreviation or using '...' instead of '\ldots' and other similar -problems. You start 'lacheck' with 'C-c C-c Check <RET>' and 'chktex' -with 'C-c C-c ChkTeX <RET>'. The result will be a list of errors in the -'*compilation*' buffer. You can go through the errors with 'C-x `' -('next-error', *note (emacs)Compilation::), which will move point to the -location of the next error. - - Alternatively, you may want in-buffer notation. AUCTeX provides -support for this using the Flymake package in Emacs 26 or newer (*note -(Flymake)Using Flymake:: for details). To enable, call 'M-x -flymake-mode <RET>' in the buffer or enable it in all buffers by adding -this to your init file: - (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook #'flymake-mode) - Note that AUCTeX currently only provides support for using 'chktex' -as the flymake backend. - - Each of the two utilities 'lacheck' and 'chktex' will find some -errors the other doesn't, but 'chktex' is more configurable, allowing -you to create your own errors. You may need to install the programs -before using them. You can get 'lacheck' from -URL:<https://www.ctan.org/pkg/lacheck> and 'chktex' from -URL:<https://www.ctan.org/pkg/chktex>. TeX Live contains both. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Control, Next: Cleaning, Prev: Checking, Up: Processing - -4.5 Controlling the output -========================== - -A number of commands are available for controlling the output of an -application running under AUCTeX - - -- Command: TeX-kill-job - ('C-c C-k') Kill currently running external application. This may - be either of TeX, LaTeX, previewer, BibTeX, etc. - - -- Command: TeX-recenter-output-buffer - ('C-c C-l') Recenter the output buffer so that the bottom line is - visible. - - -- Command: TeX-home-buffer - ('C-c ^') Go to the 'master' file in the document associated with - the current buffer, or if already there, to the file where the - current process was started. - - Additionally, output files produced by AUCTeX can be placed in a -separate directory. - - -- User Option: TeX-output-dir - Set this option to the path of a directory where output files will - be placed. The output files include those that are produced by - applications running under AUCTeX, temporary files related to - region processing and the preview-latex files. If a relative path - is specified, it is interpreted as being relative to the master - file in a mutlifile document. - - This is a buffer local variable and must be set separately for all - documents and all files in a multifile document. For example, - - %%% Local Variables: - %%% mode: latex - %%% TeX-output-dir: "build" - %%% End: - - Alternatively, you may use 'setq-default' to set the default value - of this option or set it as a directory local variable (*note - (emacs)Directory Variables::). - - Note that a non-nil value of 'TeX-output-dir' might be incompatible - with some TeX commands and macros. In particular, the LaTeX macro - '\include' is known to not work with this option. Some TeX - packages which produce intermediary files might also be - incompatible. A possible workaround for those packages is to - append the value of 'TeX-output-dir' to the environment variables - 'TEXINPUTS' and 'BIBINPUTS'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Cleaning, Next: Documentation, Prev: Control, Up: Processing - -4.6 Cleaning intermediate and output files -========================================== - - -- Command: TeX-clean - Remove generated intermediate files. In case a prefix argument is - given, remove output files as well. - - Canonical access to the function is provided by the 'Clean' and - 'Clean All' entries in 'TeX-command-list', invokable with 'C-c C-c' - or the Command menu. - - The patterns governing which files to remove can be adapted - separately for each AUCTeX mode by means of the following - variables: - * 'plain-TeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes' - * 'plain-TeX-clean-output-suffixes' - * 'LaTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes' - * 'LaTeX-clean-output-suffixes' - * 'docTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes' - * 'docTeX-clean-output-suffixes' - * 'Texinfo-clean-intermediate-suffixes' - * 'Texinfo-clean-output-suffixes' - * 'ConTeXt-clean-intermediate-suffixes' - * 'ConTeXt-clean-output-suffixes' - * 'AmSTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes' - * 'AmSTeX-clean-output-suffixes' - - -- User Option: TeX-clean-confirm - Control if deletion of intermediate and output files has to be - confirmed before it is actually done. If non-nil, ask before - deleting files. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Documentation, Prev: Cleaning, Up: Processing - -4.7 Documentation about macros and packages -=========================================== - - -- Command: TeX-documentation-texdoc - ('C-c ?') Get documentation about the packages installed on your - system, using 'texdoc' to find the manuals. The function will - prompt for the name of packages. If point is on a word, this will - be suggested as default. - - If the command is called with a prefix argument, you will be shown - a list of manuals of the given package among to choose. - - The command can be invoked by the key binding mentioned above as - well as the 'Find Documentation...' entry in the mode menu. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Customization, Next: Appendices, Prev: Processing, Up: Top - -5 Customization and Extension -***************************** - -* Menu: - -* Modes and Hooks:: Modes and Hooks -* Multifile:: Multifile Documents -* Parsing Files:: Automatic Parsing of TeX Files -* Internationalization:: Language Support -* Automatic:: Automatic Customization -* Style Files:: Writing Your Own Style Support - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Modes and Hooks, Next: Multifile, Up: Customization - -5.1 Modes and Hooks -=================== - -AUCTeX supports a wide variety of derivatives and extensions of TeX. -Besides plain TeX those are LaTeX, AMS-TeX, ConTeXt, Texinfo and docTeX. -For each of them there is a separate major mode in AUCTeX and each major -mode runs 'text-mode-hook', 'TeX-mode-hook' as well as a hook special to -the mode in this order. (As an exception, Texinfo mode does not run -'TeX-mode-hook'.) The following table provides an overview of the -respective mode functions and hooks. - -Type Mode function Hook -------------------------------------------------------- -Plain TeX 'plain-tex-mode' 'plain-TeX-mode-hook' -LaTeX 'latex-mode' 'LaTeX-mode-hook' -AMS-TeX 'ams-tex-mode' 'AmS-TeX-mode-hook' -ConTeXt 'context-mode' 'ConTeXt-mode-hook' -Texinfo 'texinfo-mode' 'Texinfo-mode-hook' -DocTeX 'doctex-mode' 'docTeX-mode-hook' - - If you need to make a customization via a hook which is only relevant -for one of the modes listed above, put it into the respective mode hook, -if it is relevant for any AUCTeX mode, add it to 'TeX-mode-hook' and if -it is relevant for all text modes, append it to 'text-mode-hook'. - - Other useful hooks are listed below. - - -- Variable: TeX-after-compilation-finished-functions - Hook which is run after the TeX/LaTeX processor has successfully - finished compiling your document. (*Note Processing::, for finding - out how to compile your document.) Each function in the hook is - run with the compiled output document as its argument. - - This is useful for automatically refreshing the viewer after - re-compilation especially when using Emacs viewers such as DocView - or PDF Tools. The function 'TeX-revert-document-buffer' can be - added to the hook for this purpose. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Multifile, Next: Parsing Files, Prev: Modes and Hooks, Up: Customization - -5.2 Multifile Documents -======================= - -You may wish to spread a document over many files (as you are likely to -do if there are multiple authors, or if you have not yet discovered the -power of the outline commands (*note Outline::)). This can be done by -having a "master" file in which you include the various files with the -TeX macro '\input' or the LaTeX macro '\include'. These files may also -include other files themselves. However, to format the document you -must run the commands on the top level master file. - - When you, for example, ask AUCTeX to run a command on the master -file, it has no way of knowing the name of the master file. By default, -it will assume that the current file is the master file. If you insert -the following in your init file ('init.el' or '.emacs'), AUCTeX will use -a more advanced algorithm. - - (setq-default TeX-master nil) ; Query for master file. - - In this case, AUCTeX will ask for the name of the master file -associated with the buffer. To avoid asking you again, AUCTeX will -automatically insert the name of the master file as a file variable -(*note (emacs)File Variables::). You can also insert the file variable -yourself, by putting the following text at the end of your files. - - %%% Local Variables: - %%% TeX-master: "master" - %%% End: - - You should always set this variable to the name of the top level -document. If you always use the same name for your top level documents, -you can set 'TeX-master' in your init file such as 'init.el' or -'.emacs'. - - (setq-default TeX-master "master") ; All master files called "master". - - -- User Option: TeX-master - The master file associated with the current buffer. If the file - being edited is actually included from another file, then you can - tell AUCTeX the name of the master file by setting this variable. - If there are multiple levels of nesting, specify the top level - file. - - If this variable is 'nil', AUCTeX will query you for the name. - - If the variable is 't', then AUCTeX will assume the file is a - master file itself. - - If the variable is 'shared', then AUCTeX will query for the name, - but will not change the file. - - If the variable is 'dwim', AUCTeX will try to avoid querying by - attempting to "do what I mean"; and then change the file. - - -- User Option: TeX-one-master - Regular expression matching ordinary TeX files. - - You should set this variable to match the name of all files, for - which it is a good idea to append a 'TeX-master' file variable - entry automatically. When AUCTeX adds the name of the master file - as a file variable, it does not need to ask next time you edit the - file. - - If you dislike AUCTeX automatically modifying your files, you can - set this variable to '"<none>"'. By default, AUCTeX will modify - any file with an extension of '.tex', '.texi' or '.dtx'. - - -- Command: TeX-master-file-ask - ('C-c _') Query for the name of a master file and add the - respective File Variables (*note (emacs)File Variables::) to the - file for setting this variable permanently. - - AUCTeX will not ask for a master file when it encounters existing - files. This function shall give you the possibility to insert the - variable manually. - - AUCTeX keeps track of macros, environments, labels, and style files -that are used in a given document. For this to work with multifile -documents, AUCTeX has to have a place to put the information about the -files in the document. This is done by having an 'auto' subdirectory -placed in the directory where your document is located. Each time you -save a file, AUCTeX will write information about the file into the -'auto' directory. When you load a file, AUCTeX will read the -information in the 'auto' directory about the file you loaded _and the -master file specified by 'TeX-master'_. Since the master file (perhaps -indirectly) includes all other files in the document, AUCTeX will get -information from all files in the document. This means that you will -get from each file, for example, completion for all labels defined -anywhere in the document. - - AUCTeX will create the 'auto' directory automatically if -'TeX-auto-save' is non-nil. Without it, the files in the document will -not know anything about each other, except for the name of the master -file. *Note Automatic Local::. - - -- Command: TeX-save-document - ('C-c C-d') Save all buffers known to belong to the current - document. - - -- User Option: TeX-save-query - If non-nil, then query the user before saving each file with - 'TeX-save-document'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Parsing Files, Next: Internationalization, Prev: Multifile, Up: Customization - -5.3 Automatic Parsing of TeX Files -================================== - -AUCTeX depends heavily on being able to extract information from the -buffers by parsing them. Since parsing the buffer can be somewhat slow, -the parsing is initially disabled. You are encouraged to enable them by -adding the following lines to your init file such as 'init.el' or -'.emacs'. - - (setq TeX-parse-self t) ; Enable parse on load. - (setq TeX-auto-save t) ; Enable parse on save. - - The latter command will make AUCTeX store the parsed information in -an 'auto' subdirectory in the directory each time the TeX files are -stored, *note Automatic Local::. If AUCTeX finds the pre-parsed -information when loading a file, it will not need to reparse the buffer. -The information in the 'auto' directory is also useful for multifile -documents, *note Multifile::, since it allows each file to access the -parsed information from all the other files in the document. This is -done by first reading the information from the master file, and then -recursively the information from each file stored in the master file. - - The variables can also be set on a per file basis, by changing the -file local variables. - - %%% Local Variables: - %%% TeX-parse-self: t - %%% TeX-auto-save: t - %%% End: - - Even when you have disabled the automatic parsing, you can force the -generation of style information by pressing 'C-c C-n'. This is often -the best choice, as you will be able to decide when it is necessary to -reparse the file. - - -- User Option: TeX-parse-self - Parse file after loading it if no style hook is found for it. - - -- User Option: TeX-auto-save - Automatically save style information when saving the buffer. - - -- Command: TeX-normal-mode ARG - ('C-c C-n') Remove all information about this buffer, and apply the - style hooks again. Save buffer first including style information. - With optional argument, also reload the style hooks. - - When AUCTeX saves your buffer, it can optionally convert all tabs in -your buffer into spaces. Tabs confuse AUCTeX's error message parsing -and so should generally be avoided. However, tabs are significant in -some environments, and so by default AUCTeX does not remove them. To -convert tabs to spaces when saving a buffer, insert the following in -your init file such as 'init.el' or '.emacs': - - (setq TeX-auto-untabify t) - - -- User Option: TeX-auto-untabify - Automatically remove all tabs from a file before saving it. - - Instead of disabling the parsing entirely, you can also speed it -significantly up by limiting the information it will search for (and -store) when parsing the buffer. You can do this by setting the default -values for the buffer local variables 'TeX-auto-regexp-list' and -'TeX-auto-parse-length' in your init file such as 'init.el' or '.emacs'. - - ;; Only parse LaTeX class and package information. - (setq-default TeX-auto-regexp-list 'LaTeX-auto-minimal-regexp-list) - ;; The class and package information is usually near the beginning. - (setq-default TeX-auto-parse-length 2000) - - This example will speed the parsing up significantly, but AUCTeX will -no longer be able to provide completion for labels, macros, -environments, or bibitems specified in the document, nor will it know -what files belong to the document. - - These variables can also be specified on a per file basis, by -changing the file local variables. - - %%% Local Variables: - %%% TeX-auto-regexp-list: TeX-auto-full-regexp-list - %%% TeX-auto-parse-length: 999999 - %%% End: - - -- User Option: TeX-auto-regexp-list - List of regular expressions used for parsing the current file. - - -- User Option: TeX-auto-parse-length - Maximal length of TeX file that will be parsed. - - The pre-specified lists of regexps are defined below. You can use -these before loading AUCTeX by quoting them, as in the example above. - - -- Constant: TeX-auto-empty-regexp-list - Parse nothing - - -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-minimal-regexp-list - Only parse LaTeX class and packages. - - -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-label-regexp-list - Only parse LaTeX labels. - - -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-index-regexp-list - Only parse LaTeX index and glossary entries. - - -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-class-regexp-list - Only parse macros in LaTeX classes and packages. - - -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-pagestyle-regexp-list - Only parse LaTeX pagestyles. - - -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-counter-regexp-list - Only parse LaTeX counters. - - -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-length-regexp-list - Only parse LaTeX lengths. - - -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-savebox-regexp-list - Only parse LaTeX saveboxes. - - -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-regexp-list - Parse common LaTeX commands. - - -- Constant: plain-TeX-auto-regexp-list - Parse common plain TeX commands. - - -- Constant: TeX-auto-full-regexp-list - Parse all TeX and LaTeX commands that AUCTeX can use. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Internationalization, Next: Automatic, Prev: Parsing Files, Up: Customization - -5.4 Language Support -==================== - -TeX and Emacs are usable for European (Latin, Cyrillic, Greek) based -languages. Some LaTeX and EmacsLisp packages are available for easy -typesetting and editing documents in European languages. - - All Emacs versions supported by current AUCTeX can handle CJK -(Chinese, Japanese, and Korean) languages by default. - - In most cases, special versions of TeX engines are needed for -high-quality typesetting of CJK languages: CTeX and ChinaTeX for -Chinese, ASCII pTeX, upTeX and NTT jTeX for Japanese, HLaTeX and kTeX -for Korean. They are necessary as well when you want to typeset -documents saved in their domestic encodings such as 'Shift-JIS'. -Currently, AUCTeX offers native support for pTeX, upTeX and jTeX only. - - If you don't need fine tuning in the result with respect to the -typesetting rules of their respective national standards, most unicode -based TeX engines, e.g. LuaTeX and XeTeX, can handle CJK languages by -default if they are encoded in UTF-8. The CJK-LaTeX package is provided -for supporting CJK scripts in a standard LaTeX document. - -* Menu: - -* European:: Using AUCTeX with European Languages -* Japanese:: Using AUCTeX with Japanese - - -File: auctex.info, Node: European, Next: Japanese, Up: Internationalization - -5.4.1 Using AUCTeX with European Languages ------------------------------------------- - -5.4.1.1 Typing and Displaying Non-ASCII Characters -.................................................. - -First you will need a way to write non-ASCII characters. You can either -use macros, or teach TeX about the ISO character sets. I prefer the -latter, it has the advantage that the usual standard emacs word movement -and case change commands will work. - - Recommended encoding for LaTeX document is UTF-8. Recent LaTeX2e has -native support for UTF-8. If your LaTeX2e is not recent enough, just -add '\usepackage[utf8]{inputenc}'. - - You can still use ISO 8859 Latin 1 encoding with -'\usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}'. - - To be able to display non-ASCII characters you will need an -appropriate font. All Emacs versions supported by current AUCTeX can -display 8-bit characters, provided that suitable fonts are installed. - - A compromise is to use an European character set when editing the -file, and convert to TeX macros when reading and writing the files. - -'iso-cvt.el' - Much like 'iso-tex.el' but is bundled with Emacs 19.23 and later. - -'X-Symbol' - a much more complete package for Emacs that can also handle a lot - of mathematical characters and input methods. - -5.4.1.2 Style Files for Different Languages -........................................... - -AUCTeX supports style files for several languages. Each style file may -modify AUCTeX to better support the language, and will run a language -specific hook that will allow you to for example change ispell -dictionary, or run code to change the keyboard remapping. The following -will for example choose a Danish dictionary for documents including -'\usepackage[danish]{babel}'. This requires parsing to be enabled, -*note Parsing Files::. - - (add-hook 'TeX-language-dk-hook - (lambda () (ispell-change-dictionary "danish"))) - - The following style files are recognized: - -'brazilian' -'brazil' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-pt-br-hook'. Gives '"' word syntax, - makes the <"> key inserts '``' or '''' depending on context. - Typing <"> twice will insert a literal '"'. Typing <-> twice will - insert '"=', three times '--'. - -'bulgarian' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-bg-hook'. Gives '"' word syntax, - makes the <"> key insert a literal '"'. Typing <"> twice will - insert '"`' or '"'' depending on context. Typing <-> twice will - insert '"=', three times '--'. - -'czech' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-cz-hook'. Pressing <"> will insert - '\uv{' and '}' depending on context. - -'danish' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-dk-hook'. Pressing <"> will insert - '"`' and '"'' depending on context. Typing <-> twice will insert - '"=', i.e. a hyphen string allowing hyphenation in the composing - words. - -'dutch' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-nl-hook'. - -'english' -'australian' -'canadian' -'newzealand' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-en-hook'. - -'frenchb' -'francais' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-fr-hook'. Pressing <"> will insert - '\og' and '\fg' depending on context. Note that the language name - for customizing 'TeX-quote-language-alist' is 'french'. - -'german' -'ngerman' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-de-hook'. Gives '"' word syntax, - makes the <"> key insert a literal '"'. Pressing the key twice - will give you opening or closing German quotes ('"`' or '"''). - Typing <-> twice will insert '"=', three times '--'. - -'icelandic' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-is-hook'. Gives '"' word syntax, - makes the <"> key insert a literal '"'. Typing <"> twice will - insert '"`' or '"'' depending on context. Typing <-> twice will - insert '"=', three times '--'. - -'italian' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-it-hook'. Pressing <"> will insert - '"<' and '">' depending on context. - -'polish' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-pl-hook'. Gives '"' word syntax and - makes the <"> key insert a literal '"'. Pressing <"> twice will - insert '"`' or '"'' depending on context. - -'polski' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-pl-hook'. Makes the <"> key insert a - literal '"'. Pressing <"> twice will insert ',,' or '''' depending - on context. - -'portuguese' -'portuges' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-pt-hook'. Gives '"' word syntax, - makes the <"> key inserts '"<' or '">' depending on context. - Typing <"> twice will insert a literal '"'. Typing <-> twice will - insert '"=', three times '--'. Note that the language name for - customizing 'TeX-quote-language-alist' is 'portuguese'. - -'slovak' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-sk-hook'. Pressing <"> will insert - '\uv{' and '}' depending on context. - -'swedish' - Runs style hook 'TeX-language-sv-hook'. Pressing <"> will insert - ''''. Typing <-> twice will insert '"=', three times '--'. - - Replacement of language-specific hyphen strings like '"=' with dashes -does not require to type <-> three times in a row. You can put point -after the hypen string anytime and trigger the replacement by typing -<->. - - In case you are not satisfied with the suggested behavior of quote -and hyphen insertion you can change it by customizing the variables -'TeX-quote-language-alist' and 'LaTeX-babel-hyphen-language-alist' -respectively. - - -- User Option: TeX-quote-language-alist - Used for overriding the default language-specific quote insertion - behavior. This is an alist where each element is a list consisting - of four items. The first item is the name of the language in - concern as a string. See the list of supported languages above. - The second item is the opening quotation mark. The third item is - the closing quotation mark. Opening and closing quotation marks - can be specified directly as strings or as functions returning a - string. The fourth item is a boolean controlling quote insertion. - It should be non-nil if if the special quotes should only be used - after inserting a literal '"' character first, i.e. on second key - press. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-babel-hyphen-language-alist - Used for overriding the behavior of hyphen insertion for specific - languages. Every element in this alist is a list of three items. - The first item should specify the affected language as a string. - The second item denotes the hyphen string to be used as a string. - The third item, a boolean, controls the behavior of hyphen - insertion and should be non-nil if the special hyphen should be - inserted after inserting a literal '-' character, i.e. on second - key press. - - The defaults of hyphen insertion are defined by the variables -'LaTeX-babel-hyphen' and 'LaTeX-babel-hyphen-after-hyphen' respectively. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-babel-hyphen - String to be used when typing <->. This usually is a hyphen - alternative or hyphenation aid provided by 'babel' and the related - language style files, like '"=', '"~' or '"-'. - - Set it to an empty string or nil in order to disable - language-specific hyphen insertion. - - -- User Option: LaTeX-babel-hyphen-after-hyphen - Control insertion of hyphen strings. If non-nil insert normal - hyphen on first key press and swap it with the language-specific - hyphen string specified in the variable 'LaTeX-babel-hyphen' on - second key press. If nil do it the other way round. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Japanese, Prev: European, Up: Internationalization - -5.4.2 Using AUCTeX with Japanese TeX ------------------------------------- - -To write Japanese text with AUCTeX, you need the versions of TeX and -Emacs that support Japanese. AUCTeX supports three Japanese TeX engines -by default: NTT jTeX, ASCII pTeX and upTeX. - - Activate 'japanese-plain-tex-mode' or 'japanese-latex-mode' to use -the Japanese TeX engines. If it doesn't work, send mail to Masayuki -Ataka <masayuki.ataka@gmail.com> or Ikumi Keita -<ikumikeita@jcom.home.ne.jp>, who currently concern with stuff related -to Japanese in AUCTeX. None of the primary AUCTeX maintainers -understand Japanese, so they cannot help you. - - It is recommended to enable 'TeX-parse-self' for typical Japanese -LaTeX users. When enabled, 'japanese-latex-mode' selects the suitable -Japanese TeX engine automatically based on the class file name (such as -'jbook', 'jsarticle' and 'tjreport') and its option. *Note Parsing -Files::. - - It is important to select the suitable Japanese TeX engine because -the selected engine determines the command name such as 'platex' and -'uptex' to typeset the document. If you find that wrong command is -used, check the value of 'TeX-engine' on that buffer. If the value does -not suit the current document, change the value by the 'TeXing Options' -submenu below the 'Command' menu. *Note Processor Options::. - - To make the selected engine to persist across Emacs sessions, there -are two ways from which you can choose one according to your needs: - - 1. If you use a specific engine (almost) exclusively, customize the - option 'japanese-TeX-engine-default'. - - -- User Option: japanese-TeX-engine-default - The default 'TeX-engine' in Japanese TeX mode. - - The default value is 'ptex'. - 2. If you want to set the engine on a per file basis, use the file - local variables to set 'TeX-engine'. - - Here is a sample code to set 'TeX-engine' to 'uptex': - - %%% Local Variables: - %%% mode: japanese-latex - %%% TeX-engine: uptex - %%% End: - - In the both cases above, the valid value is one of 'ptex', 'jtex' and -'uptex'. - - You can override the command names associated with the above three -engines or define your own engine by customizing 'TeX-engine-alist'. -*Note Processor Options::. - - It is sometimes necessary to use an engine which differs from the one -AUCTeX selects automatically. For example, even when you want to use -'j-article' document class deliberately with ASCII pLaTeX, AUCTeX -selects NTT jLaTeX command if 'TeX-parse-self' is enabled, because -'j-article' originally belongs to NTT jLaTeX. In such cases, use the -file local variable method above to select the engine you intend to use. - - If you usually use AUCTeX in Japanese, setting the following -variables is useful. - - -- User Option: TeX-default-mode - Mode to enter for a new file when it cannot be determined whether - the file is plain TeX or LaTeX or what. - - If you want to enter Japanese LaTeX mode whenever this may happen, - set the variable like this: - (setq TeX-default-mode 'japanese-latex-mode) - - -- User Option: japanese-LaTeX-default-style - The default style/class when creating a new Japanese LaTeX - document. - - The default value is '"jarticle"'. - - It is recommended also for Japanese users to customize the option -'TeX-PDF-from-DVI' to '"Dvipdfmx"'. *Note Processor Options::. - - There are three customize options with regard to the encoding of -Japanese text. - - -- User Option: japanese-TeX-use-kanji-opt-flag - If non-nil, AUCTeX adds '-kanji' option to the typesetting command - when 'TeX-engine' is 'ptex'. - - Usually AUCTeX guesses the right coding systems for input to and -output from the Japanese TeX process, but you can override them by the -following two customize options. - - -- User Option: TeX-japanese-process-input-coding-system - If non-nil, used for encoding input to Japanese TeX process. When - 'nil', AUCTeX tries to choose suitable coding system. - - -- User Option: TeX-japanese-process-output-coding-system - If non-nil, used for decoding output from Japanese TeX process. - When 'nil', AUCTeX tries to choose suitable coding system. - - The former customize options 'japanese-TeX-command-default', -'japanese-LaTeX-command-default' and 'japanese-TeX-command-list' are -removed from AUCTeX. Use 'japanese-TeX-engine-default' instead. If you -need to customize the executable file name such as '"latex"', the -options for them, or both, customize 'TeX-engine-alist'. - - The following two additional font commands are available in LaTeX -mode buffer. - -'C-c C-f g' - Insert gothic font command '\textgt{-!-}' or '\mathgt{-!-}' - depending on the context. - -'C-c C-f m' - Insert mincho font command '\textmc{-!-}' or '\mathmc{-!-}' - depending on the context. - - Although they are meaningful only with 'ptex' and 'uptex' engines, it -won't matter in buffers with other engines. - - See 'tex-jp.el' for more information. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Automatic, Next: Style Files, Prev: Internationalization, Up: Customization - -5.5 Automatic Customization -=========================== - -Since AUCTeX is so highly customizable, it makes sense that it is able -to customize itself. The automatic customization consists of scanning -TeX files and extracting symbols, environments, and things like that. - - The automatic customization is done on three different levels. The -global level is the level shared by all users at your site, and consists -of scanning the standard TeX style files, and any extra styles added -locally for all users on the site. The private level deals with those -style files you have written for your own use, and use in different -documents. You may have a '~/lib/TeX/' directory where you store useful -style files for your own use. The local level is for a specific -directory, and deals with writing customization for the files for your -normal TeX documents. - - If compared with the environment variable 'TEXINPUTS', the global -level corresponds to the directories built into TeX. The private level -corresponds to the directories you add yourself, except for '.', which -is the local level. - -* Menu: - -* Automatic Global:: Automatic Customization for the Site -* Automatic Private:: Automatic Customization for a User -* Automatic Local:: Automatic Customization for a Directory - - By default AUCTeX will search for customization files in all the -global, private, and local style directories, but you can also set the -path directly. This is useful if you for example want to add another -person's style hooks to your path. Please note that all matching files -found in 'TeX-style-path' are loaded, and all hooks defined in the files -will be executed. - - -- User Option: TeX-style-path - List of directories to search for AUCTeX style files. - - By default, when AUCTeX searches a directory for files, it will -recursively search through subdirectories. - - -- User Option: TeX-file-recurse - Whether to search TeX directories recursively: nil means do not - recurse, a positive integer means go that far deep in the directory - hierarchy, t means recurse indefinitely. - - By default, AUCTeX will ignore files named '.', '..', 'SCCS', 'RCS', -and 'CVS'. - - -- User Option: TeX-ignore-file - Regular expression matching file names to ignore. - - These files or directories will not be considered when searching - for TeX files in a directory. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Automatic Global, Next: Automatic Private, Up: Automatic - -5.5.1 Automatic Customization for the Site ------------------------------------------- - -Assuming that the automatic customization at the global level was done -when AUCTeX was installed, your choice is now: will you use it? If you -use it, you will benefit by having access to all the symbols and -environments available for completion purposes. The drawback is slower -load time when you edit a new file and perhaps too many confusing -symbols when you try to do a completion. - - You can disable the automatic generated global style hooks by setting -the variable 'TeX-auto-global' to nil. - - -- User Option: TeX-macro-global - Directories containing the site's TeX style files. - - -- User Option: TeX-style-global - Directory containing hand generated TeX information. - - These correspond to TeX macros shared by all users of a site. - - -- User Option: TeX-auto-global - Directory containing automatically generated information. - - For storing automatic extracted information about the TeX macros - shared by all users of a site. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Automatic Private, Next: Automatic Local, Prev: Automatic Global, Up: Automatic - -5.5.2 Automatic Customization for a User ----------------------------------------- - -You should specify where you store your private TeX macros, so AUCTeX -can extract their information. The extracted information will go to the -directories listed in 'TeX-auto-private' - - Use 'M-x TeX-auto-generate <RET>' to extract the information. - - -- User Option: TeX-macro-private - Directories where you store your personal TeX macros. The value - defaults to the directories listed in the 'TEXINPUTS' and - 'BIBINPUTS' environment variables or to the respective directories - in '$TEXMFHOME' of 'kpsewhich' setting if no results can be - obtained from the environment variables. - - -- User Option: TeX-auto-private - List of directories containing automatically generated AUCTeX style - files. These correspond to the personal TeX macros. - - -- Command: TeX-auto-generate TEX AUTO - ('M-x TeX-auto-generate <RET>') Generate style hook for TEX and - store it in AUTO. If TEX is a directory, generate style hooks for - all files in the directory. - - -- User Option: TeX-style-private - List of directories containing hand generated AUCTeX style files. - These correspond to the personal TeX macros. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Automatic Local, Prev: Automatic Private, Up: Automatic - -5.5.3 Automatic Customization for a Directory ---------------------------------------------- - -AUCTeX can update the style information about a file each time you save -it, and it will do this if the directory 'TeX-auto-local' exists. -'TeX-auto-local' is by default set to '"auto"', so simply creating an -'auto' directory will enable automatic saving of style information. - - The advantage of doing this is that macros, labels, etc. defined in -any file in a multifile document will be known in all the files in the -document. The disadvantage is that saving will be slower. To disable, -set 'TeX-auto-local' to nil. - - -- User Option: TeX-style-local - Directory containing hand generated TeX information. - - These correspond to TeX macros found in the current directory. - - -- User Option: TeX-auto-local - Directory containing automatically generated TeX information. - - These correspond to TeX macros found in the current directory. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Style Files, Prev: Automatic, Up: Customization - -5.6 Writing Your Own Style Support -================================== - -*Note Automatic::, for a discussion about automatically generated -global, private, and local style files. The hand generated style files -are equivalent, except that they by default are found in 'style' -directories instead of 'auto' directories. - -* Menu: - -* Simple Style:: A Simple Style File -* Adding Macros:: Adding Support for Macros -* Adding Environments:: Adding Support for Environments -* Adding Other:: Adding or Examining Other Information -* Hacking the Parser:: Automatic Extraction of New Things - - If you write some useful support for a public TeX style file, please -send it to us. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Simple Style, Next: Adding Macros, Up: Style Files - -5.6.1 A Simple Style File -------------------------- - -Here is a simple example of a style file. - - ;;; book.el - Special code for book style. - - (TeX-add-style-hook - "book" - (lambda () - (LaTeX-largest-level-set "part")) - TeX-dialect) - - The example is from the AUCTeX sources and is loaded for any LaTeX -document using the book document class (or style before LaTeX2e). (Note -that the above code is much simplified for explanatory purpose.) The -file specifies that the largest kind of section in such a document is -'part'. The interesting thing to notice is that the style file defines -an (anonymous) function, and adds it to the list of loaded style hooks -by calling 'TeX-add-style-hook'. - - The first time the user indirectly tries to access some -style-specific information, such as the largest sectioning command -available, the style hooks for all files directly or indirectly read by -the current document are executed. The actual files will only be -evaluated once, but the hooks will be called for each buffer using the -style file. - - Note that the basename of the style file and the name of the style -hook should usually be identical. - - -- Function: TeX-add-style-hook STYLE HOOK &optional DIALECT-EXPR - Add HOOK to the list of functions to run when we use the TeX file - STYLE and the current dialect is one in the set derived from - DIALECT-EXPR. When DIALECT-EXPR is omitted, then HOOK is allowed - to be run whatever the current dialect is. - - DIALECT-EXPR may be one of: - - * A symbol indicating a singleton containing one basic TeX - dialect, this symbol shall be selected among: - ':latex' - For all files in LaTeX mode, or any mode derived thereof. - ':bibtex' - For all files in BibTeX mode, or any mode derived - thereof. - ':texinfo' - For all files in Texinfo mode. - ':plain-tex' - For all files in plain-TeX mode, or any mode derived - thereof. - ':context' - For all files in ConTeXt mode. - ':classopt' - For class options of LaTeX document. This is provided as - pseudo-dialect for style hooks associated with class - options. - * A logical expression like: - '(or DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 ... DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N)' - For union of the sets of dialects corresponding to - DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 through DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N - '(and DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 ... DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N)' - For intersection of the sets of dialects corresponding to - DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 through DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N - '(nor DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 ... DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N)' - For complement of the union sets of dialects - corresponding to DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 through - DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N relatively to the set of all - supported dialects - '(not DIALECT-EXPR)' - For complement set of dialect corresponding to - DIALECT-EXPR relatively to the set of all supported - dialects - - In case of adding a style hook for LaTeX, when calling function -'TeX-add-style-hook' it is thought more futureproof for argument -DIALECT-EXPR to pass constant 'TeX-dialect' currently defined to -':latex', rather than passing ':latex' directly. - - -- Constant: TeX-dialect - Default dialect for use with function 'TeX-add-style-hook' for - argument DIALECT-EXPR when the hook is to be run only on LaTeX - file, or any mode derived thereof. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Adding Macros, Next: Adding Environments, Prev: Simple Style, Up: Style Files - -5.6.2 Adding Support for Macros -------------------------------- - -The most common thing to define in a style hook is new symbols (TeX -macros). Most likely along with a description of the arguments to the -function, since the symbol itself can be defined automatically. - - Here are a few examples from 'latex.el'. - - (TeX-add-style-hook - "latex" - (lambda () - (TeX-add-symbols - '("arabic" TeX-arg-counter) - '("label" TeX-arg-define-label) - '("ref" TeX-arg-ref) - '("newcommand" TeX-arg-define-macro [ "Number of arguments" ] t) - '("newtheorem" TeX-arg-define-environment - [ TeX-arg-environment "Numbered like" ] - t [ TeX-arg-counter "Within counter" ])))) - - -- Function: TeX-add-symbols SYMBOL ... - Add each SYMBOL to the list of known symbols. - - Each argument to 'TeX-add-symbols' is a list describing one symbol. -The head of the list is the name of the symbol, the remaining elements -describe each argument. - - If there are no additional elements, the symbol will be inserted with -point inside braces. Otherwise, each argument of this function should -match an argument of the TeX macro. What is done depends on the -argument type. - - If a macro is defined multiple times, AUCTeX will choose the one with -the longest definition (i.e. the one with the most arguments). - - Thus, to overwrite - '("tref" 1) ; one argument - you can specify - '("tref" TeX-arg-ref ignore) ; two arguments - - 'ignore' is a function that does not do anything, so when you insert -a 'tref' you will be prompted for a label and no more. - - You can use the following types of specifiers for arguments: - -'string' - Use the string as a prompt to prompt for the argument. - -'number' - Insert that many braces, leave point inside the first. 0 and -1 - are special. 0 means that no braces are inserted. -1 means that - braces are inserted around the macro and an active region (e.g. - '{\tiny foo}'). If there is no active region, no braces are - inserted. - -'nil' - Insert empty braces. - -'t' - Insert empty braces, leave point between the braces. - -'other symbols' - Call the symbol as a function. You can define your own hook, or - use one of the predefined argument hooks. - -'list' - If the car is a string, insert it as a prompt and the next element - as initial input. Otherwise, call the car of the list with the - remaining elements as arguments. - -'vector' - Optional argument. If it has more than one element, parse it as a - list, otherwise parse the only element as above. Use square - brackets instead of curly braces, and is not inserted on empty user - input. - - A lot of argument hooks have already been defined. The first -argument to all hooks is a flag indicating if it is an optional -argument. It is up to the hook to determine what to do with the -remaining arguments, if any. Typically the next argument is used to -overwrite the default prompt. - -'TeX-arg-conditional' - Implements if EXPR THEN ELSE. If EXPR evaluates to true, parse - THEN as an argument list, else parse ELSE as an argument list. - -'TeX-arg-literal' - Insert its arguments into the buffer. Used for specifying extra - syntax for a macro. - -'TeX-arg-free' - Parse its arguments but use no braces when they are inserted. - -'TeX-arg-eval' - Evaluate arguments and insert the result in the buffer. - -'TeX-arg-label' - Prompt for a label completing with known labels. If RefTeX is - active, prompt for the reference format. - -'TeX-arg-ref' - Prompt for a label completing with known labels. If RefTeX is - active, do not prompt for the reference format. Usually, reference - macros should use this function instead of 'TeX-arg-label'. - -'TeX-arg-index-tag' - Prompt for an index tag. This is the name of an index, not the - entry. - -'TeX-arg-index' - Prompt for an index entry completing with known entries. - -'TeX-arg-length' - Prompt for a LaTeX length completing with known lengths. - -'TeX-arg-macro' - Prompt for a TeX macro with completion. - -'TeX-arg-date' - Prompt for a date, defaulting to the current date. The format of - the date is specified by the 'TeX-date-format' option. If you want - to change the format when the 'babel' package is loaded with a - specific language, set 'TeX-date-format' inside the appropriate - language hook (for details *note European::). - -'TeX-arg-version' - Prompt for the version of a file, using as initial input the - current date. - -'TeX-arg-environment' - Prompt for a LaTeX environment with completion. - -'TeX-arg-cite' - Prompt for a BibTeX citation. If the variable - 'TeX-arg-cite-note-p' is non-nil, ask also for optional note in - citations. - -'TeX-arg-counter' - Prompt for a LaTeX counter completing with known counters. - -'TeX-arg-savebox' - Prompt for a LaTeX savebox completing with known saveboxes. - -'TeX-arg-file' - Prompt for a filename in the current directory, and use it with the - extension. - -'TeX-arg-file-name' - Prompt for a filename and use as initial input the name of the file - being visited in the current buffer, with extension. - -'TeX-arg-file-name-sans-extension' - Prompt for a filename and use as initial input the name of the file - being visited in the current buffer, without extension. - -'TeX-arg-input-file' - Prompt for the name of an input file in TeX's search path, and use - it without the extension. Run the style hooks for the file. (Note - that the behavior (type of prompt and inserted file name) of the - function can be controlled by the variable - 'TeX-arg-input-file-search'.) - -'TeX-arg-define-label' - Prompt for a label completing with known labels. Add label to list - of defined labels. - -'TeX-arg-define-length' - Prompt for a LaTeX length completing with known lengths. Add - length to list of defined lengths. - -'TeX-arg-define-macro' - Prompt for a TeX macro with completion. Add macro to list of - defined macros. - -'TeX-arg-define-environment' - Prompt for a LaTeX environment with completion. Add environment to - list of defined environments. - -'TeX-arg-define-cite' - Prompt for a BibTeX citation. - -'TeX-arg-define-counter' - Prompt for a LaTeX counter. - -'TeX-arg-define-savebox' - Prompt for a LaTeX savebox. - -'TeX-arg-document' - Prompt for a LaTeX document class, using 'LaTeX-default-style' as - default value and 'LaTeX-default-options' as default list of - options. If the variable 'TeX-arg-input-file-search' is t, you - will be able to complete with all LaTeX classes available on your - system, otherwise classes listed in the variable 'LaTeX-style-list' - will be used for completion. It is also provided completion for - options of many common classes. - -'LaTeX-arg-usepackage' - Prompt for LaTeX packages. If the variable - 'TeX-arg-input-file-search' is t, you will be able to complete with - all LaTeX packages available on your system. It is also provided - completion for options of many common packages. - -'TeX-arg-bibstyle' - Prompt for a BibTeX style file completing with all style available - on your system. - -'TeX-arg-bibliography' - Prompt for BibTeX database files completing with all databases - available on your system. - -'TeX-arg-corner' - Prompt for a LaTeX side or corner position with completion. - -'TeX-arg-lr' - Prompt for a LaTeX side with completion. - -'TeX-arg-tb' - Prompt for a LaTeX side with completion. - -'TeX-arg-pagestyle' - Prompt for a LaTeX pagestyle with completion. - -'TeX-arg-verb' - Prompt for delimiter and text. - -'TeX-arg-verb-delim-or-brace' - Prompt for delimiter and text. This function is similar to - 'TeX-arg-verb', but is intended for macros which take their - argument enclosed in delimiters or in braces. - -'TeX-arg-pair' - Insert a pair of numbers, use arguments for prompt. The numbers - are surrounded by parentheses and separated with a comma. - -'TeX-arg-size' - Insert width and height as a pair. No arguments. - -'TeX-arg-coordinate' - Insert x and y coordinates as a pair. No arguments. - -'LaTeX-arg-author' - Prompt for document author, using 'LaTeX-default-author' as initial - input. - -'TeX-read-hook' - Prompt for a LaTeX hook and return it. - -'TeX-arg-hook' - Prompt for a LaTeX hook and insert it as a TeX macro argument. - -'TeX-read-key-val' - Prompt for a 'key=value' list of options and return them. - -'TeX-arg-key-val' - Prompt for a 'key=value' list of options and insert it as a TeX - macro argument. - - If you add new hooks, you can assume that point is placed directly -after the previous argument, or after the macro name if this is the -first argument. Please leave point located after the argument you are -inserting. If you want point to be located somewhere else after all -hooks have been processed, set the value of 'TeX-exit-mark'. It will -point nowhere, until the argument hook sets it. - - Some packages provide macros that are rarely useful to non-expert -users. Those should be marked as expert macros using -'TeX-declare-expert-macros'. - - -- Function: TeX-declare-expert-macros STYLE MACROS... - Declare MACROS as expert macros of STYLE. - - Expert macros are completed depending on - 'TeX-complete-expert-commands'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Adding Environments, Next: Adding Other, Prev: Adding Macros, Up: Style Files - -5.6.3 Adding Support for Environments -------------------------------------- - -Adding support for environments is very much like adding support for TeX -macros, except that each environment normally only takes one argument, -an environment hook. The example is again a short version of -'latex.el'. - - (TeX-add-style-hook - "latex" - (lambda () - (LaTeX-add-environments - '("document" LaTeX-env-document) - '("enumerate" LaTeX-env-item) - '("itemize" LaTeX-env-item) - '("list" LaTeX-env-list)))) - - It is completely up to the environment hook to insert the -environment, but the function 'LaTeX-insert-environment' may be of some -help. The hook will be called with the name of the environment as its -first argument, and extra arguments can be provided by adding them to a -list after the hook. - - For simple environments with arguments, for example defined with -'\newenvironment', you can make AUCTeX prompt for the arguments by -giving the prompt strings in the call to 'LaTeX-add-environments'. The -fact that an argument is optional can be indicated by wrapping the -prompt string in a vector. - - For example, if you have defined a 'loop' environment with the three -arguments FROM, TO, and STEP, you can add support for them in a style -file. - - %% loop.sty - - \newenvironment{loop}[3]{...}{...} - - ;; loop.el - - (TeX-add-style-hook - "loop" - (lambda () - (LaTeX-add-environments - '("loop" "From" "To" "Step")))) - - If an environment is defined multiple times, AUCTeX will choose the -one with the longest definition. Thus, if you have an enumerate style -file, and want it to replace the standard LaTeX enumerate hook above, -you could define an 'enumerate.el' file as follows, and place it in the -appropriate style directory. - - (TeX-add-style-hook - "latex" - (lambda () - (LaTeX-add-environments - '("enumerate" LaTeX-env-enumerate foo)))) - - (defun LaTeX-env-enumerate (environment &optional _ignore) ...) - - The symbol 'foo' will be passed to 'LaTeX-env-enumerate' as the -second argument, but since we only added it to overwrite the definition -in 'latex.el' it is just ignored. - - -- Function: LaTeX-add-environments ENV ... - Add each ENV to list of loaded environments. - - -- Function: LaTeX-insert-environment ENV [ EXTRA ] - Insert environment of type ENV, with optional argument EXTRA. - - Following is a list of available hooks for 'LaTeX-add-environments': - -'LaTeX-env-item' - Insert the given environment and the first item. - -'LaTeX-env-figure' - Insert the given figure-like environment with a caption and a - label. - -'LaTeX-env-array' - Insert the given array-like environment with position and column - specifications. - -'LaTeX-env-label' - Insert the given environment with a label. - -'LaTeX-env-list' - Insert the given list-like environment, a specifier for the label - and the first item. - -'LaTeX-env-minipage' - Insert the given minipage-like environment with position and width - specifications. - -'LaTeX-env-tabular*' - Insert the given tabular*-like environment with width, position and - column specifications. - -'LaTeX-env-picture' - Insert the given environment with width and height specifications. - -'LaTeX-env-bib' - Insert the given environment with a label for a bibitem. - -'LaTeX-env-contents' - Insert the given environment with a filename as its argument. - -'LaTeX-env-args' - Insert the given environment with arguments. You can use this as a - hook in case you want to specify multiple complex arguments just - like in elements of 'TeX-add-symbols'. This is most useful if the - specification of arguments to be prompted for with strings and - strings wrapped in a vector as described above is too limited. - - Here is an example from 'listings.el' which calls a function with - one argument in order to prompt for a 'key=value' list to be - inserted as an optional argument of the 'lstlisting' environment: - - (LaTeX-add-environments - '("lstlisting" LaTeX-env-args - [TeX-arg-key-val LaTeX-listings-key-val-options])) - - Some packages provide environments that are rarely useful to -non-expert users. Those should be marked as expert environments using -'LaTeX-declare-expert-environments'. - - -- Function: LaTeX-declare-expert-environments STYLE ENVIRONMENTS... - Declare ENVIRONMENTS as expert environments of STYLE. - - Expert environments are completed depending on - 'TeX-complete-expert-commands'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Adding Other, Next: Hacking the Parser, Prev: Adding Environments, Up: Style Files - -5.6.4 Adding or Examining Other Information -------------------------------------------- - -5.6.4.1 Adding bibliographies in style hooks -............................................ - -You can also specify bibliographical databases and labels in the style -file. This is probably of little use, since this information will -usually be automatically generated from the TeX file anyway. - - -- Function: LaTeX-add-bibliographies BIBLIOGRAPHY ... - Add each BIBLIOGRAPHY to list of loaded bibliographies. - - -- Function: LaTeX-add-labels LABEL ... - Add each LABEL to the list of known labels. - -5.6.4.2 Examining Package/Class Options -....................................... - -In LaTeX documents, style hooks can find the package names and those -options given as optional argument(s) of '\usepackage' in -'LaTeX-provided-package-options'. - - -- Variable: LaTeX-provided-package-options - Buffer local variable holding alist of options provided to LaTeX - packages. Each element is a cons cell '(PACKAGE . OPTION-LIST)'. - For example, its value will be - (("babel" . ("german")) - ("geometry" . ("a4paper" "top=2cm" "left=2.5cm" "right=2.5cm")) - ...) - - You can examine whether there is a specific package-option pair by -'LaTeX-provided-package-options-member'. - - -- Function: LaTeX-provided-package-options-member PACKAGE OPTION - Return non-'nil' if OPTION has been given to PACKAGE. The value is - actually the tail of the list of options given to PACKAGE. - - There are similar facilities for class names and those options given -in '\documentclass' declaration. - - -- Variable: LaTeX-provided-class-options - Buffer local variable holding alist of options provided to LaTeX - classes. Each element is a cons cell '(CLASS . OPTION-LIST)'. For - example, its value will be - (("book" . ("a4paper" "11pt" "openany" "fleqn")) - ...) - - -- Function: LaTeX-provided-class-options-member CLASS OPTION - Return non-'nil' if OPTION has been given to CLASS. The value is - actually the tail of the list of options given to CLASS. - - -- Function: LaTeX-match-class-option REGEXP - Check if a documentclass option matching REGEXP is active. Return - first found class option matching REGEXP, or nil if not found. - - These functions are also useful to implement customized predicate(s) -in 'TeX-view-predicate-list'. *Note Starting Viewers::. - -5.6.4.3 Adding Support for Option Completion -............................................ - -When the user inserts '\usepackage' by 'C-c C-m', AUCTeX asks for the -optional arguments after the package name is given. The style file of -that package can provide completion support for the optional arguments. - - -- Variable: LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options - List of optional arguments available for the package. - - Here is an excerption from 'acronym.el': - (defvar LaTeX-acronym-package-options - '("footnote" "nohyperlinks" "printonlyused" "withpage" - "smaller" "dua" "nolist") - "Package options for the acronym package.") - - When the package accepts key-value style optional arguments, more -sophisticated completion support is needed. The package style file can -provide dynamic completion support by custom elisp function. - - -- Function: LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options - This function should ask the user for optional arguments and return - them as a string, instead of built-in option query facility. When - this function is defined, AUCTeX calls it with no argument. - - Here is an excerption from 'acro.el': - (defun LaTeX-acro-package-options () - "Prompt for package options for the acro package." - (TeX-read-key-val t LaTeX-acro-package-options-list)) - - As you can see in the above example, a utility function -'TeX-read-key-val' is available to read key-value pair(s) from users. - - Note that 'defvar' or 'defun' of 'LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options' -should be at the top level of the style file and not inside the style -hook, because the style hook is not yet called when the user inputs the -optional arguments in response to 'C-c C-m'. - - There are similar facilities for class options. When the user -inserts '\documentclass' by 'C-c C-e', the respective class style file -can provide completion support for the optional arguments. - - -- Variable: LaTeX-CLASSNAME-class-options - List of optional arguments available for the class. - - -- Function: LaTeX-CLASSNAME-class-options - Which see. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Hacking the Parser, Prev: Adding Other, Up: Style Files - -5.6.5 Automatic Extraction of New Things ----------------------------------------- - -The automatic TeX information extractor works by searching for regular -expressions in the TeX files, and storing the matched information. You -can add support for new constructs to the parser, something that is -needed when you add new commands to define symbols. - - For example, in the file 'macro.tex' I define the following macro. - - \newcommand{\newmacro}[5]{% - \def#1{#3\index{#4@#5~cite{#4}}\nocite{#4}}% - \def#2{#5\index{#4@#5~cite{#4}}\nocite{#4}}% - } - - AUCTeX will automatically figure out that 'newmacro' is a macro that -takes five arguments. However, it is not smart enough to automatically -see that each time we use the macro, two new macros are defined. We can -specify this information in a style hook file. - - ;;; macro.el --- Special code for my own macro file. - - ;;; Code: - - (defvar TeX-newmacro-regexp - '("\\\\newmacro{\\\\\\([a-zA-Z]+\\)}{\\\\\\([a-zA-Z]+\\)}" - (1 2) TeX-auto-multi) - "Matches \\newmacro definitions.") - - (defvar TeX-auto-multi nil - "Temporary for parsing \\newmacro definitions.") - - (defun TeX-macro-cleanup () - "Move symbols from `TeX-auto-multi' to `TeX-auto-symbol'." - (mapc (lambda (list) - (mapc (lambda (symbol) - (setq TeX-auto-symbol - (cons symbol TeX-auto-symbol))) - list)) - TeX-auto-multi)) - - (defun TeX-macro-prepare () - "Clear `Tex-auto-multi' before use." - (setq TeX-auto-multi nil)) - - (add-hook 'TeX-auto-prepare-hook #'TeX-macro-prepare) - (add-hook 'TeX-auto-cleanup-hook #'TeX-macro-cleanup) - - (TeX-add-style-hook - "macro" - (lambda () - (TeX-auto-add-regexp TeX-newmacro-regexp) - (TeX-add-symbols '("newmacro" - TeX-arg-macro - (TeX-arg-macro "Capitalized macro: \\") - t - "BibTeX entry: " - nil)))) - - ;;; macro.el ends here - - When this file is first loaded, it adds a new entry to -'TeX-newmacro-regexp', and defines a function to be called before the -parsing starts, and one to be called after the parsing is done. It also -declares a variable to contain the data collected during parsing. -Finally, it adds a style hook which describes the 'newmacro' macro, as -we have seen it before. - - So the general strategy is: Add a new entry to 'TeX-newmacro-regexp'. -Declare a variable to contain intermediate data during parsing. Add -hook to be called before and after parsing. In this case, the hook -before parsing just initializes the variable, and the hook after parsing -collects the data from the variable, and adds them to the list of -symbols found. - - -- Variable: TeX-auto-regexp-list - List of regular expressions matching TeX macro definitions. - - The list has the following format ((REGEXP MATCH TABLE) ...), that - is, each entry is a list with three elements. - - REGEXP. Regular expression matching the macro we want to parse. - - MATCH. A number or list of numbers, each representing one - parenthesized subexpression matched by REGEXP. - - TABLE. The symbol table to store the data. This can be a - function, in which case the function is called with the argument - MATCH. Use 'TeX-match-buffer' to get match data. If it is not a - function, it is presumed to be the name of a variable containing a - list of match data. The matched data (a string if MATCH is a - number, a list of strings if MATCH is a list of numbers) is put in - front of the table. - - -- Variable: TeX-auto-prepare-hook nil - List of functions to be called before parsing a TeX file. - - -- Variable: TeX-auto-cleanup-hook nil - List of functions to be called after parsing a TeX file. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Appendices, Next: Indices, Prev: Customization, Up: Top - -Appendix A Copying, Changes, Development, FAQ, Texinfo Mode -*********************************************************** - -* Menu: - -* Copying this Manual:: -* Changes:: -* Development:: -* FAQ:: -* Texinfo mode:: - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Copying this Manual, Next: Changes, Up: Appendices - -A.1 Copying this Manual -======================= - -The copyright notice for this manual is: - - This manual is for AUCTeX (version 13.1.3 from 2022-04-16), a -sophisticated TeX environment for Emacs. - - Copyright (C) 1992-1995, 2001, 2002, 2004-2022 Free Software -Foundation, Inc. - - Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this - document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, - Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software - Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts and no - Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section - entitled "GNU Free Documentation License." - - The full license text can be read here: - -* Menu: - -* GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: GNU Free Documentation License, Up: Copying this Manual - -A.1.1 GNU Free Documentation License ------------------------------------- - - Version 1.3, 3 November 2008 - - Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008 Free Software - Foundation, Inc. <https://fsf.org/> - - Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies - of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. - - 0. PREAMBLE - - The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other - functional and useful document "free" in the sense of freedom: to - assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it, - with or without modifying it, either commercially or - noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the - author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not - being considered responsible for modifications made by others. - - This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that derivative - works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. - It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft - license designed for free software. - - We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for - free software, because free software needs free documentation: a - free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms - that the software does. But this License is not limited to - software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless - of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. We - recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is - instruction or reference. - - 1. APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS - - This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, - that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can - be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice - grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, - to use that work under the conditions stated herein. The - "Document", below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member - of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as "you". You accept - the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a way - requiring permission under copyright law. - - A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work containing the - Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with - modifications and/or translated into another language. - - A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter section - of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the - publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall - subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could - fall directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document - is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not - explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of - historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or - of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position - regarding them. - - The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections whose - titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the - notice that says that the Document is released under this License. - If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it - is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may - contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify - any Invariant Sections then there are none. - - The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that are - listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice - that says that the Document is released under this License. A - Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may - be at most 25 words. - - A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, - represented in a format whose specification is available to the - general public, that is suitable for revising the document - straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed - of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely - available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text - formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats - suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise - Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has - been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by - readers is not Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if - used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not - "Transparent" is called "Opaque". - - Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain - ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, - SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming - simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. - Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. - Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be read and - edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which - the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and - the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word - processors for output purposes only. - - The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page itself, - plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the - material this License requires to appear in the title page. For - works in formats which do not have any title page as such, "Title - Page" means the text near the most prominent appearance of the - work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text. - - The "publisher" means any person or entity that distributes copies - of the Document to the public. - - A section "Entitled XYZ" means a named subunit of the Document - whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses - following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ - stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as - "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", "Endorsements", or "History".) - To "Preserve the Title" of such a section when you modify the - Document means that it remains a section "Entitled XYZ" according - to this definition. - - The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice - which states that this License applies to the Document. These - Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in - this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other - implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and - has no effect on the meaning of this License. - - 2. VERBATIM COPYING - - You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either - commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the - copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License - applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you - add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You - may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading - or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, - you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you - distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the - conditions in section 3. - - You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, - and you may publicly display copies. - - 3. COPYING IN QUANTITY - - If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly - have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and - the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must - enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all - these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and - Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly - and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The - front cover must present the full title with all words of the title - equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the - covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as - long as they preserve the title of the Document and satisfy these - conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other respects. - - If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit - legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit - reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto - adjacent pages. - - If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document - numbering more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable - Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with - each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which the general - network-using public has access to download using public-standard - network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free - of added material. If you use the latter option, you must take - reasonably prudent steps, when you begin distribution of Opaque - copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will - remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one - year after the last time you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or - through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the public. - - It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of - the Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, - to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the - Document. - - 4. MODIFICATIONS - - You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document - under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you - release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the - Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing - distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever - possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in - the Modified Version: - - A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title - distinct from that of the Document, and from those of previous - versions (which should, if there were any, be listed in the - History section of the Document). You may use the same title - as a previous version if the original publisher of that - version gives permission. - - B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or - entities responsible for authorship of the modifications in - the Modified Version, together with at least five of the - principal authors of the Document (all of its principal - authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you - from this requirement. - - C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the - Modified Version, as the publisher. - - D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document. - - E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications - adjacent to the other copyright notices. - - F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license - notice giving the public permission to use the Modified - Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in - the Addendum below. - - G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant - Sections and required Cover Texts given in the Document's - license notice. - - H. Include an unaltered copy of this License. - - I. Preserve the section Entitled "History", Preserve its Title, - and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new - authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on the - Title Page. If there is no section Entitled "History" in the - Document, create one stating the title, year, authors, and - publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add - an item describing the Modified Version as stated in the - previous sentence. - - J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document - for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and - likewise the network locations given in the Document for - previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the - "History" section. You may omit a network location for a work - that was published at least four years before the Document - itself, or if the original publisher of the version it refers - to gives permission. - - K. For any section Entitled "Acknowledgements" or "Dedications", - Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section - all the substance and tone of each of the contributor - acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein. - - L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered - in their text and in their titles. Section numbers or the - equivalent are not considered part of the section titles. - - M. Delete any section Entitled "Endorsements". Such a section - may not be included in the Modified Version. - - N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled - "Endorsements" or to conflict in title with any Invariant - Section. - - O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers. - - If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or - appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no - material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate - some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their - titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's - license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other - section titles. - - You may add a section Entitled "Endorsements", provided it contains - nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various - parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text - has been approved by an organization as the authoritative - definition of a standard. - - You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, - and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of - the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage - of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or - through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document - already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added - by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on - behalf of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old - one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added - the old one. - - The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this - License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to - assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version. - - 5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS - - You may combine the Document with other documents released under - this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for - modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all - of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, - unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your - combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all - their Warranty Disclaimers. - - The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and - multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single - copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name - but different contents, make the title of each such section unique - by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the - original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a - unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in - the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the - combined work. - - In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled - "History" in the various original documents, forming one section - Entitled "History"; likewise combine any sections Entitled - "Acknowledgements", and any sections Entitled "Dedications". You - must delete all sections Entitled "Endorsements." - - 6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS - - You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other - documents released under this License, and replace the individual - copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy - that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the - rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents - in all other respects. - - You may extract a single document from such a collection, and - distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert - a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this - License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that - document. - - 7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS - - A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other - separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a - storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the - copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the - legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual - works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this - License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which - are not themselves derivative works of the Document. - - If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these - copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half - of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed - on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the - electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic - form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket - the whole aggregate. - - 8. TRANSLATION - - Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may - distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section - 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special - permission from their copyright holders, but you may include - translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the - original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a - translation of this License, and all the license notices in the - Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also - include the original English version of this License and the - original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a - disagreement between the translation and the original version of - this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will - prevail. - - If a section in the Document is Entitled "Acknowledgements", - "Dedications", or "History", the requirement (section 4) to - Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the - actual title. - - 9. TERMINATION - - You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document - except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt - otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void, - and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. - - However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your - license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) - provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and - finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the - copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some - reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation. - - Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is - reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the - violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have - received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from - that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days - after your receipt of the notice. - - Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate - the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you - under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not - permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the - same material does not give you any rights to use it. - - 10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE - - The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of - the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new - versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may - differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See - <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. - - Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version - number. If the Document specifies that a particular numbered - version of this License "or any later version" applies to it, you - have the option of following the terms and conditions either of - that specified version or of any later version that has been - published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the - Document does not specify a version number of this License, you may - choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free - Software Foundation. If the Document specifies that a proxy can - decide which future versions of this License can be used, that - proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently - authorizes you to choose that version for the Document. - - 11. RELICENSING - - "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site" (or "MMC Site") means any - World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also - provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A - public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server. - A "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration" (or "MMC") contained in the - site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC - site. - - "CC-BY-SA" means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0 - license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit - corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco, - California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license - published by that same organization. - - "Incorporate" means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or - in part, as part of another Document. - - An MMC is "eligible for relicensing" if it is licensed under this - License, and if all works that were first published under this - License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently - incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover - texts or invariant sections, and (2) were thus incorporated prior - to November 1, 2008. - - The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the - site under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1, - 2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing. - -ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents ----------------------------------------------------- - -To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of -the License in the document and put the following copyright and license -notices just after the title page: - - Copyright (C) YEAR YOUR NAME. - Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document - under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 - or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; - with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover - Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU - Free Documentation License''. - - If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover -Texts, replace the "with...Texts." line with this: - - with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with - the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts - being LIST. - - If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other -combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the -situation. - - If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we -recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of free -software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to permit -their use in free software. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Changes, Next: Development, Prev: Copying this Manual, Up: Appendices - -A.2 Changes and New Features -============================ - -News since last release ------------------------ - - * AUCTeX now requires GNU Emacs 25.1 or higher. - - * AUCTeX tracks the change in Emacs where initial inputs in the - minibuffer during queries are getting phased out. Queries for the - mandatory arguments of macros and environments are adjusted where - applicable. The value which will be used after hitting 'RET' - without other input is shown in the prompt in parentheses prefixed - with 'default'. For this change the signature of the function - 'TeX-arg-length' is altered. The old argument list was: - (defun TeX-arg-length (optional &optional prompt - initial-input definition default) - - whereas the new one is: - (defun TeX-arg-length (optional &optional prompt - default initial-input definition) - - Note the position change of 'DEFAULT'. - - * Indenting of conditionals is improved. Code inside constructs like - '\ifx . \else . \fi' is correctly indented. An interface for style - files is also introduced which can add their macros to the - indentation engine. Check the file 'algpseudocode.el' for an - example. - - * You can optionally enable indent inside square brackets '[]' by new - user options 'TeX-indent-open-delimiters' and - 'TeX-indent-close-delimiters'. *Note Indenting::. - - * Now 'tex-buf.el' is merged into 'tex.el' and no longer exists. If - your personal code has '(require 'tex-buf)', one of the following - prescriptions would serve. - 1. Remove '(require 'tex-buf)'. - 2. Replace it with '(require 'tex)'. - 3. Replace it with '(require 'latex)'. - -News in 13.1 ------------- - - * In math environments 'gather', 'gather*', 'gathered', 'multline' - and 'multline*', fill commands such as 'M-q' and 'C-c C-q C-e' are - disabled. This sorts out the inconsistency between those and - 'equation', 'displaymath' environments, in latter of which filling - is already disabled. - - If you want filling in such environments, customize - 'LaTeX-indent-environment-list' to remove them. - - Auto fill continues to work in such environment anyway. - - In addition, AUCTeX adds support of alignment at '&' sign in - 'align'-like environments such as 'alignat', 'aligned' and so on, - as well as 'matrix'-like environments such as 'pmatrix', 'bmatrix' - and so on. - - * Now two commands 'Texindex' and 'Texi2dvi' are available when you - type 'C-c C-c' in Texinfo mode. The command 'Texindex' runs - 'texindex' on index files and 'Texi2dvi' runs 'pdftexi2dvi' or - 'texi2dvi' according to the value of 'TeX-PDF-mode'. - - So you can typeset Texinfo documents into PDF or DVI format from - within AUCTeX. - - * AUCTeX's own help messages for LaTeX errors are now shown only for - LaTeX runs. AUCTeX shows raw error/warning messages found in - '.log' files for runs of formats other than LaTeX, such as plain - TeX, ConTeXt and Texinfo, as it does even for LaTeX runs when it - can't find a matching entry in its own help message catalogue. - - Due to this change, customize option 'TeX-error-description-list' - can no longer have a fallback entry that matches any error. If - your customized value includes such entry, typically '(".*" . "No - help available")', please remove it. - - * Two functions 'TeX-split-string' and 'TeX-assoc' are now obsolete - and will be removed in future release. If your personal code uses - these functions, use 'split-string' and 'assoc-string' instead. - - * The function 'TeX-read-key-val' now accepts a function call as - second argument. This change should help AUCTeX style writers who - use 'TeX-arg-key-val' and have to deal with dynamic key-values. - Example of usage: - (TeX-add-style-hook "foo" - (lambda () - (TeX-add-symbols - '("bar" (TeX-arg-key-val (function-returning-key-val)))))) - - * Since AUCTeX 12.2, 'C-x C-w' accidentally disabled the parse on - save in that buffer, even when you enabled 'TeX-auto-save' option. - This bug was fixed. - - * AUCTeX now requires GNU Emacs 24.3 or higher. - - * Old implementations for viewers were discarded, as announced long - before. The variables 'TeX-output-view-style' and 'TeX-view-style' - have no effect now. The former placeholders '%v' and '%vv' in - 'TeX-command-list' are ignored. - - * AUCTeX now uses lexical binding which has been introduced in Emacs - 24. This change should have no user-visible effect and require no - manual adaptions except in the following cases. - - - Entries added to the customization variable 'TeX-expand-list' - also had access to variables 'command' and 'pos'. Those are - now properly declared and named 'TeX-expand-command' and - 'TeX-expand-pos'. - - - Entries added to the customization variable 'TeX-expand-list' - had access to a variable 'file' which was bound to - 'TeX-active-master', i.e., it evaluated to either the master - or region file. This usage must be replaced with either - 'TeX-active-master' or 'TeX-active-master-with-quotes'. - - - Viewer entries in 'TeX-view-program-list' also had access to a - variable 'file' which was bound to the name of the master or - region file without extension. Instead, the function - 'TeX-active-master' has to be used now. - - - Macro argument parsing functions could set a variable - 'exit-mark' to the buffer position where point should be left - after all arguments have been read. This variable is now - named 'TeX-exit-mark'. - - - The functions in 'LaTeX-section-hook' had access or modified - the previously undeclared variables 'title', 'name', 'level', - 'done-mark', and 'toc'. These variables are now properly - declared and have the 'LaTeX-' prefix, e.g., - 'LaTeX-done-mark'. - - - The functions in 'ConTeXt-numbered-section-hook' and - 'ConTeXt-unnumbered-section-hook' had access or modified the - previously undeclared variables 'title', 'name', 'level', - 'done-mark', and 'reference'. These variables are now - properly declared and have the 'ConTeXt-' prefix, e.g., - 'ConTeXt-title'. - - - The functions in 'TeX-translate-location-hook' could access - and modify the free variables 'file', 'line', 'error', - 'offset', 'context', and 'string'. Those are now properly - declared variables with the prefix 'TeX-translate-location-', - e.g., 'TeX-translate-location-file'. - - * The constant 'LaTeX-dialect' has been renamed to 'TeX-dialect' and - moved from 'latex.el' to 'tex.el'. 'LaTeX-dialect' now is an - obsolete alias. - - * The style 'latexinfo.el' is removed from AUCTeX. 'latexinfo.el' - was meant to support latexinfo which in return was a LaTeX-2.09 - extension of Texinfo, but didn't manage to replace Texinfo. - - * The style 'siunitx.el' is updated to support package version 3. - Key-value options provided by older package versions are removed, - deprecated macros and units are not supported anymore. - - * AUCTeX has preliminary support for LaTeX-hooks. Hooks provided by - LaTeX kernel are known and available for completion in - '\AddToHook', '\RemoveFromHook' and '\AddToHookNext'. - - * AUCTeX is now able to place all generated output files, including - those that are produced by applications running under AUCTeX, - temporary files related to region processing and preview-latex - files, in an output directory. To use this feature, set the new - user option 'TeX-output-dir' to the absolute path of the output - directory or a relative path which would be interpreted as being - relative to the master file in a multifile document. - - Note that this feature doesn't work if the document includes sub - file placed in sub directory below the main file via '\include' - command. - - * Many other bugs were fixed. - -News in 12.3 ------------- - - * Support for 'PSTricks' is now PDF-oriented. AUCTeX no longer turns - off PDF mode for 'PSTricks' documents even without 'pst-pdf'. It - now sets up 'TeX-PDF-from-DVI' option so that PDF output is - generated when 'TeX-PDF-mode' is enabled (default). Users who want - DVI output should disable PDF mode explicitly by file local - variable, or customize 'TeX-PDF-mode' to 'nil'. - - * The function 'font-latex-update-font-lock' has been obsoleted in - order to fix 'bug#37945'. That function was used by several style - files in order to refresh fontification after adding new symbols or - verbatim constructs. It is better to call 'font-lock-flush' in the - former case and 'font-latex-set-syntactic-keywords' in the latter - case. The function 'font-latex-update-font-lock' still exists as a - no-op which only shows a warning explaining how to update font-lock - as mentioned above. - - * Math expression highlighting was improved. Highlighting for - documents with a lot of inline math expressions '$...$' won't get - scrambled now ('bug#33139'). - - In addition, it is no longer recommended to customize - 'font-latex-math-environments'. Use 'texmathp-tex-commands' - instead. *Note Fontification of math::. - - * AUCTeX tracks changes in LaTeX2e 2020-02-02 release. AUCTeX - supports the improvements to LaTeX font selection mechanism (NFSS). - New macros like '\textsw' or '\textulc' are added to font insertion - keyboard commands. *Note Font Specifiers::, for details. Further, - the entries in the menu 'LaTeX', 'Insert Font' are reorganized and - adjusted accordingly. - - Macros previously provided by 'textcomp.sty' are now part of LaTeX - kernel. AUCTeX tracks this change as well and support for the new - macro '\legacyoldstylenums' is added. - - * Insertion of environments in LaTeX documents (i.e. 'C-c C-e') was - improved. The former code had a few bugs, which sometimes resulted - in either spurious empty line or spurious comment prefix, or both, - especially when the region is active. Those bugs are now fixed. - - * More bugs fixed, other minor features implemented. - -News in 12.2 ------------- - - * AUCTeX reflects the changes in LaTeX2e 2019-10-01 release. - 'filecontents' environment now takes an optional argument and can - be used anywhere in a document. The macros '\Ref' and - '\labelformat' are moved from 'varioref.sty' to LaTeX kernel. - 'amsmath' has a new macro '\overunderset'. - - * A new method is implemented in preview-latex to adjust the - foreground colors of generated images to those of Emacs, when the - LaTeX command produces PDF. The traditional method became invalid - because of the change introduced in Ghostscript 9.27. - Unfortunately, the new method doesn't work due to a bug in - Ghostscript 9.27 and is valid only for Ghostscript > 9.27. There - is also a fallback method for gs 9.27 users which displays plain - "black on white" images. For successful function of preview-latex, - the users are encouraged to set up the new user option - 'preview-pdf-color-adjust-method' to choose appropriate option - among the three: new, traditional and fallback method. - - * AUCTeX has support for the Flymake package in Emacs 26 or newer. - To enable, call 'M-x flymake-mode <RET>' or add this to your - '.emacs' file: - (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook #'flymake-mode) - - * The way the option 'TeX-record-buffer' is used was corrected. It - was used in just the opposite way as the document says. Erase the - customization if you have customized this option since it now acts - in reverse to your expectation. - - * A former customize option 'japanese-TeX-command-list' is removed. - Use 'japanese-TeX-engine-default', or if it's really necessary, - customize 'TeX-command-list' directly if the task which the option - used to carry is required. - - * Support for standard LaTeX without e-TeX extension is now very - limited. It doesn't work if raw TeX code is put on the command - line to invoke 'latex' command. It also fails for region - compilation ('C-c C-r' and so on) with documents of non-ascii file - name. In addition, it no longer works with preview-latex. We - consider this incompatibility is permissible because e-TeX - extension is enabled for standard LaTeX by default long ago. LaTeX - variants such as XeLaTeX and LuaLaTeX are not affected. - - * Key binds in Texinfo mode are improved. Typing '$', '^', '_' and - '\' now just self-inserts without pointless side effects in Texinfo - mode. - - In addition, the option 'TeX-electric-escape' is now effective in - Texinfo mode. When it is enabled, typing '@' will invoke - 'TeX-electric-macro' offering completion in similar style with - other TeX modes of AUCTeX. - - * Fontification support for 'biblatex' package is improved and - updated to macros provided by package version 3.12. For qualified - lists, at least 2 mandatory arguments are fontified. - - * Support for column specifiers 'w' and 'W' provided by 'array' - package is added to 'array.el'. The correct counting of columns - only works when the 'align' parameter is enclosed in braces, e.g., - 'w{l}{3cm}'. The short version 'wl{3cm}' is not supported. - - * Entries for 'PDF Tools' are added in - 'TeX-view-program-list-builtin' for Windows and macOS. This viewer - can be configured under these operating systems with an entry like - this in an init file: - (setq TeX-view-program-selection '((output-pdf "PDF Tools"))) - - * Several other bugs were fixed, many minor features were added. - -News in 12.1 ------------- - - * AUCTeX now requires GNU Emacs 24 or higher. Support for XEmacs has - been dropped. - - * Besides the change in the supported version of Emacs, there has - been no functional change in this release, which is equivalent to - version 11.92. - -News in 11.92 -------------- - - * preview-latex is compatible with Ghostscript 9.22 where the - operator '.runandhide' is removed. All occurrences of - '.runandhide' in preview-latex are replaced by alternative code - making it work with Ghostscript 9.22 again. - - * AUCTeX has a new customize option - 'TeX-math-input-method-off-regexp'. When you begin to input a math - formula, the current input method is turned off if its name matches - this regular expression. - - In fact this variable was introduced long before, but has not been - documented in info files nor turned into a customize option with - 'defcustom' until this release. - - * The window system focus is pulled back to Emacs when viewing with - evince-compatible viewers if a new customize option - 'TeX-view-evince-keep-focus' is non-nil. - - * The usual dose of bug fixes was administered. - -News in 11.91 -------------- - - * Now AUCTeX has a logo. The LaTeX code to create it is available in - the 'etc/' directory of the package. - - * Add support for 'upmendex', an extension of 'makeindex' capable of - sorting indexes by unicode based ICU. - - * Fix preview-latex to interact correctly with Japanese LaTeX. The - parsing routine was made robust not to be confused by the 7-bit - encoding of Japanese text and the necessary option to LaTeX command - is kept even when preamble caching is enabled. - - * The new "Glossaries" entry in 'TeX-command-list' runs the command - 'makeglossaries'. - - * Fontification of control symbols has been improved. Characters - defined in 'font-latex-match-simple-exclude-list' do not receive - any fontification. In DocTeX mode, the character '_' is removed - from 'font-latex-match-simple-exclude-list' in order to fontify - macros like '\__module_foo:nnn' correctly. - - * Fontification of math environments has been improved. Optional - and/or mandatory argument(s) to environments are not fontified. - - * 'preview.sty' loads 'luatex85.sty' if possible and should be - compatible with newer luaTeX versions. - - * AUCTeX has a new customize option 'TeX-ispell-verb-delimiters'. - This string contains usual characters used as delimiters for - in-line verbatim macros like '\verb'. Text between delimiters - after an in-line verbatim macro will be skipped during spell - checking. - - * Fontification of in-line verbatim macros has been improved. - 'font-latex.el' recognizes an optional or a mandatory argument for - macros like '\Verb' from 'fancyvrb.sty', '\mint' and '\mintinline' - from 'minted.sty' and fontifies verbatim content correctly. - - * AUCTeX can put and parse labels in optional argument of - environments. Inserting labels is done by new function - 'LaTeX-env-label-as-keyval'. A new customize option - 'LaTeX-listing-label' is available as prefix to labels in code - typesetting environments, e.g. 'lstlisting' environment provided by - 'listings' package. 'LaTeX-listing-label' defaults to 'lst:'. - Parsing of labels for later referencing relies on two requirements: - 1. Label should come as last key-value argument, and - 2. label must be enclosed in braces, e.g. - \begin{lstlisting}[caption=Some Caption,label={lst:foo}] - ... - \end{lstlisting} - - * The function 'LaTeX-label' now takes a second optional argument - 'NO-INSERT'. When non-'nil', 'LaTeX-label' reads a label and - returns it as a string. This argument is also passed to any - function bound to 'LaTeX-label-function' (see next item). - - * *Incompatible change:* The signature for the function passed with - the customize option 'LaTeX-label-function' has changed. The - function bound to this variable is now expected to take an optional - second argument 'NO-INSERT'. When this argument is non-'nil', the - function should read and only return a label as a string; insertion - is done by another function. - - * Directory local variables were ineffective for - 'japanese-latex-mode' and 'japanese-plain-tex-mode'. This bug was - fixed. (This was actually done in AUCTeX 11.90, but not - advertised) - - * The output of Japanese text from Japanese TeX engines is decoded - correctly for most cases, according to the encoding of the TeX - documents and the locale. The difference between MS Windows, macOS - and unix-like OS is taken into account. (This was actually done in - AUCTeX 11.90, but not advertised) - - * Quite a few new LaTeX packages are supported. - - * As usual, many bugs were fixed. - -News in 11.90 -------------- - - * In addition to the completion performed by 'TeX-complete-symbol', - AUCTeX now also supports the new Emacs standard completion-at-point - facility (see the Emacs command 'completion-at-point'). This also - means that modern completion UIs like company-mode work out of the - box in TeX and LaTeX buffers. *Note Completion::, for details. - - * Completion is now aware of being inside a math environment and then - completes math macros. - - * AUCTeX is able to display several levels of super- and subscripts, - each one raised above and a bit smaller than its basis. For this - feature, have a look at the customize options - 'font-latex-fontify-script' (especially the new values - 'multi-level' and 'invisible') and - 'font-latex-fontify-script-max-level'. Also, the script characters - '^' and '_' are also fontified with a special face named - 'font-latex-script-char-face'. *Note Fontification of math::, for - details. - - * Parsing of format specification in various tabular environments has - been improved. The function 'LaTeX-insert-item' ('C-c <LFD>') - inserts suitable number of ampersands for '*{num}{cols}' - constructs. Style files for LaTeX packages 'tabularx', 'tabulary', - 'longtable', 'dcolumn' and 'siunitx' are adapted to take advantage - of this improvement. - - * AUCTeX has a new Ispell dictionary 'tex-ispell.el' for macros and - environments which will be skipped during spell checking. The - activiation of this feature is controlled by a new customize option - 'TeX-ispell-extend-skip-list', which is set to 't' and activated by - default. - - * AUCTeX has a new customize option 'TeX-raise-frame-function' that - is currently only used by Evince and Atril inverse search to raise - the Emacs frame. - - * When inserting a new float, AUCTeX will now prompt for a - short-caption if the length of the caption provided is greater than - a certain size. This size is controlled via a new user option - 'LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length'. - - * Parsing of the compilation log has been reworked. You should - encounter fewer mistaken files while navigating through errors and - warnings. - - * Two new user options, 'TeX-ignore-warnings' and - 'TeX-suppress-ignored-warnings', allow ignoring certain warnings - after compilation of the document. *Note Ignoring warnings::, for - details. - - * A new option, 'TeX-PDF-from-DVI', controls if and how to produce a - PDF file by converting a DVI file. This supersedes - 'TeX-PDF-via-dvips-ps2pdf' which is still recognized but marked as - obsolete and may be removed in future releases. - - * Support for a number of external viewers has been added: - * Atril viewer. Forward and inverse search requires version - 1.9.1 or later to work. - - * dviout viewer on Windows. Note that this setup works when - 'TeX-source-correlate-method' is set to use 'source-specials' - for DVI, e.g.: - (setq TeX-source-correlate-method - '((dvi . source-specials) - (pdf . synctex))) - which is the default. - - * SumatraPDF viewer on Windows. - - * Zathura viewer. Forward and inverse search requires a recent - version of the program to work (3.4 or later). - - * A new function, 'TeX-documentation-texdoc', for reading - documentation with 'texdoc' has been added. 'TeX-doc' is still - available but now 'C-c ?' runs 'TeX-documentation-texdoc'. - - * AUCTeX has a new custom option - 'LaTeX-reftex-cite-format-auto-activate' which controls the - automatic activation of citation formats provided by RefTeX when a - style file is loaded and RefTeX is enabled. Currently, - 'biblatex.el', 'harvard.el', 'jurabib.el' and 'natbib.el' use this - feature. If you have customized 'reftex-cite-format' and want to - use your settings, you should set this variable to 'nil'. - - * AUCTeX now has limited support for the TikZ package. For the - moment, this includes some basic support for prompting the user of - arguments to the '\draw' macro. - - * The style 'graphicx.el' went through a bigger overhaul. The - optional argument of command '\includegraphics' now supports - key-val query; keys can independently be chosen anytime by pressing - the <,> key. As a side effect, the variable - 'LaTeX-includegraphics-options-alist' is now no-op and is removed - from 'tex-style.el'. You can safely remove any customization of it - from your init file. The mandatory argument of '\includegraphics' - knows about image file extensions supported by the used engine and - offers them for inclusion. - - * Support for other LaTeX packages was improved, and style files for - several new packages were added. - - * Many bugs were crushed along the way. - -News in 11.89 -------------- - - * You can now run all commands needed to compile a document and then - open the viewer with a single command: 'TeX-command-run-all', bound - to 'C-c C-a'. - - * Commands such as 'LaTeX' and 'View' can now be executed - conveniently on the current section (or part, chapter, subsection, - etc). See 'LaTeX-command-section' and - 'LaTeX-command-section-change-level'. *Note Starting a Command::, - for details. - - * Forward and backward search with Evince now also work when only a - region of the document is compiled/viewed. - - * To open the PDF output file you can now use also PDF Tools, a - document viewer for Emacs. With it, as a plus, forward and - backward search is accurate at word level. - - * With new option 'TeX-PDF-via-dvips-ps2pdf' it is possible to - compile a document to DVI and then convert it to PDF using - 'dvips'-'ps2pdf' before viewing it. - - * New option 'TeX-file-line-error' allows to select file:line:error - style for error messages. - - * Indent '\[...\]' math mode as a regular environment by default. - - * Now AUCTeX suggests to run 'makeindex' when appropriate. - - * 'TeX-view-program-list' can contain, as third optional element of - each item, the name of the executable(s) needed to open the viewer. - - * 'TeX-expand-list' variable has been split into 'TeX-expand-list' - and 'TeX-expand-list-builtin'. Only the former is intended to be - customized by the user, the latter contains built-in expanders. - You might want to keep in 'TeX-expand-list' only new expansion - strings. - - * Before running commands like TeX and LaTeX, now AUCTeX performs - some checks. If 'TeX-check-TeX' is non-nil, it will test whether a - working TeX distribution is actually present in the system and - available to Emacs. Instead, when 'TeX-check-engine' is non-nil, - before running LaTeX commands AUCTeX will check whether the correct - engine has been set, based upon known restrictions posed by LaTeX - packages. - - * Basic support to ConTeXt Mark IV has been added. Users can now - select the Mark version to be used with new option - 'ConTeXt-Mark-version', and AUCTeX is able to catch error messages - in the output log of a Mark IV document. - - * Support for tons of LaTeX packages has been added. - - * Numbers of bugs have been fixed, many minor features have been - added. - -News in 11.88 -------------- - - * 'TeX-PDF-mode' is now enabled by default. - - * Now 'TeX-previous-error' works with TeX commands if the new option - 'TeX-parse-all-errors' is non-nil, which is the default. When this - option is non-nil, an overview of errors and warnings reported by - the TeX compiler can be opened with 'M-x TeX-error-overview <RET>'. - *Note Debugging::, for details. - - * Style file authors are encouraged to distinguish common from expert - macros and environments, and mark the latter using - 'TeX-declare-expert-macros' and - 'LaTeX-declare-expert-environments'. - - Users can then restrict completion using - 'TeX-complete-expert-commands'. - - * Management of LaTeX package options in the parser was improved. - You might need to reparse your documents, especially if you loaded - the 'babel' package with language options. - - * Now you can insert '$...$' or '\(...\)' by typing a single '$'. To - do this, customize the new option 'TeX-electric-math'. - 'TeX-math-close-double-dollar' was removed. *Note Quotes::, for - details. - - * 'C-c <RET> documentclass <RET>' completes with all available LaTeX - classes, if the 'TeX-arg-input-file-search' variable is non-nil. - Completion for class options of the standard LaTeX classes is - provided as well. - - * New user options 'LaTeX-default-author', - 'LaTeX-fontspec-arg-font-search', - 'LaTeX-fontspec-font-list-default', 'TeX-date-format', and - 'TeX-insert-braces-alist'. A new possible value - ('show-all-optional-args') for 'TeX-insert-macro-default-style' was - added. The default value of 'TeX-source-correlate-method' has been - changed. - - * 'biblatex' support was greatly expanded. If parsing is enabled, - AUCTeX looks at 'backend' option to decide whether to use Biber or - BibTeX. The 'LaTeX-biblatex-use-Biber' variable was changed to be - file local only and is no more customizable. - - * With some LaTeX classes, the default environment suggested by - 'LaTeX-environment' ('C-c C-e') when the current environment is - 'document' was changed. With 'beamer' class the default - environment is 'frame', with 'letter' it is 'letter', with 'slides' - it is 'slide'. - - * Brace pairing feature was enhanced in LaTeX documents. Support for - '\bigl', '\Bigl', '\biggl' and '\Biggl', the same as the one for - '\left', was added to 'TeX-insert-macro'. For example, 'C-c <RET> - bigl <RET> ( <RET>' inserts '\bigl(\bigr)'. - - You can insert brace pair '()', '{}' and '[]' by typing a single - left brace if the new user option 'LaTeX-electric-left-right-brace' - is enabled. - - Macros '\langle', '\lfloor' and '\lceil', which produce the left - part of the paired braces, are treated similarly as '(', '{' and - '[' during the course of 'TeX-insert-macro'. *Note Quotes::, for - details. - - * Support for dozens of LaTeX packages was added. - - * Tabular-like environments ('tabular', 'tabular*', 'tabularx', - 'tabulary', 'array', 'align', ...) are indented in a nicer and - more informative way when the column values of a table line are - written across multiple lines in the tex file. - - * The suitable number of ampersands are inserted when you insert - 'array', 'tabular' and 'tabular*' environments with 'C-c C-e'. - Similar experience is obtained if you terminate rows in these - environments with 'C-c <LFD>'. It supplies line break macro '\\' - and inserts the suitable number of ampersands on the next line. - - Similar supports are provided for various 'amsmath' environments. - - *Note Tabular-like::, for details. - - * Commands for narrowing to a group ('TeX-narrow-to-group') and to - LaTeX environments ('LaTeX-narrow-to-environment') were added. - - * Now arbitrary options can be passed to the TeX processor on a per - file basis using the 'TeX-command-extra-options' option. *Note - Processor Options::, for details. - - * Now 'C-c C-e document <RET>', in an empty document, prompts for - '\usepackage' macros in addition to '\documentclass'. - - * 'TeX-add-style-hook' has now a third argument to tell AUCTeX for - which dialect (LaTeX, Texinfo or BibTeX) the style hook is - registers. Labelling style hook by dialect will avoid applying - them not in the right context. - - * There have been lots of bug fixes and feature additions. - -News in 11.87 -------------- - - * AUCTeX now supports Biber in conjunction with biblatex in addition - to BibTeX. - - * Each AUCTeX mode now has its own abbrev table. On Emacsen which - provide the possibility to inherit abbrevs from other tables, the - abbrevs from the Text mode abbrev table are available as well. - Newly defined abbrevs are written to the mode-specific tables, - though. - - * The file 'tex-fptex.el' was removed. - - * Forward/backward search for Evince has been improved. If Emacs is - compiled with DBUS support and a recent Evince version (3.x) is - installed, the communication goes over the desktop bus instead of - the command line, resulting in more accurate positioning of point - in Emacs and highlighting of the target paragraph in Evince. - - * A problem where Ghostscript threw an '/invalidfileaccess' error - when running preview-latex was fixed. - - * A lot of smaller fixes and additions have been made. - -News in 11.86 -------------- - - * Parsing of LaTeX output was improved. It is now less likely that - AUCTeX opens a non-existent file upon calling 'TeX-next-error'; a - problem for example encountered when using MiKTeX 2.8. In addition - quoted file names as emitted by MiKTeX are now supported. - - * A new framework for the definition and selection of viewers was - implemented. If you have customizations regarding viewers you will - have to redo them in this new framework or reenable the old one. - *Note Starting Viewers::, for details. - - * Comprehensive editing support for PSTricks was added. - - * Support for various LaTeX packages was added, e.g. 'tabularx', - 'CJK', and 'hyperref'. - - * An easy way to switch between TeX engines (PDFTeX, LuaTeX, XeTeX, - Omega) was added. - - * Support for SyncTeX was added. This involves the command line - options for LaTeX and the viewer. - - * Folding can now be customized to use macro arguments as replacement - text. - - * 'preview.sty' now works with XeTeX. - - * A lot of smaller and larger bugs have been squashed. - -News in 11.85 -------------- - - * Font locking has been improved significantly. It is now less prone - to color bleeding which could lead to high resource usage. In - addition it now includes information about LaTeX macro syntax and - can indicate syntactically incorrect macros in LaTeX mode. - - * The license was updated to GPLv3. - - * Support for the nomencl, flashcards and comment LaTeX packages as - well as the Icelandic language option of babel were added. - - * Support for folding of math macros was added. - - * Lots of minor bugs in features and documentation fixed. - -News in 11.84 -------------- - - * There have been problems with the '-without-texmf-dir' option to - 'configure' when the value of '-with-kpathsea-sep' was set or - determined for an installation system with a default different from - that of the runtime system. 'with-kpathsea-sep' has been removed; - the setting is now usually determined at runtime. - - Due to this and other problems, preview-latex in the released - XEmacs package failed under Windows or with anything except recent - 21.5 XEmacsen. - - * AUCTeX and preview-latex have been changed in order to accommodate - file names containing spaces. preview-latex now tolerates bad - PostScript code polluting the stack (like some Omega fonts). - - * 'preview.sty' had in some cases failed to emit PostScript header - specials. - - * Support for folding of comments was added. - - * The 'polish' language option of the babel LaTeX package as well as - the polski LaTeX package are now supported. Most notably this - means that AUCTeX will help to insert quotation marks as defined by - 'polish.sty' ('"`..."'') and 'polski.sty' (',,...'''). - - * The TeX tool bar is now available and enabled by default in plain - TeX mode. *Note Processing Facilities::. - - * Bug fix in the display of math subscripts and superscripts. - - * Bug fix 'TeX-doc' for Emacs 21. - - * There has been quite a number of other bug fixes to various - features and documentation across the board. - -News in 11.83 -------------- - - * The new function 'TeX-doc' provides easy access to documentation - about commands and packages or information related to TeX and - friends in general. *Note Documentation::. - - * You can now get rid of generated intermediate and output files by - means of the new 'Clean' and 'Clean All' entries in - 'TeX-command-list' accessible with 'C-c C-c' or the Command menu. - *Note Cleaning::. - - * Support for forward search with PDF files was added. That means - you can jump to a place in the output file corresponding to the - position in the source file. *Note Viewing::. - - Adding support for this feature required the default value of the - variable 'TeX-output-view-style' to be changed. Please make sure - you either remove any customizations overriding the new default or - incorporate the changes into your customizations if you want to use - this feature. - - * TeX error messages of the '-file-line-error' kind are now - understood in AUCTeX and preview-latex (parsers are still - separate). - - * Bug fix in XyMTeX support. - - * The LaTeX tool bar is now enabled by default. *Note Processing - Facilities::. - -News in 11.82 -------------- - - * Support for the MinionPro LaTeX package was added. - - * Warnings and underfull/overfull boxes are now being indicated in - the echo area after a LaTeX run, if the respective debugging - options are activated with 'TeX-toggle-debug-warnings' ('C-c C-t - C-w') or 'TeX-toggle-debug-bad-boxes' ('C-c C-t C-b'). In this - case 'TeX-next-error' will find these warnings in addition to - normal errors. - - The key binding 'C-c C-w' for 'TeX-toggle-debug-bad-boxes' (which - was renamed from 'TeX-toggle-debug-boxes') now is deprecated. - - * AUCTeX now can automatically insert a pair of braces after typing - <_> or <^> in math constructs if the new variable - 'TeX-electric-sub-and-superscript' is set to a non-nil value. - - * Some language-specific support for French was added. There now is - completion support for the commands provided by the 'frenchb' (and - 'francais') options of the babel LaTeX package and easier input of - French quotation marks ('\og ...\fg') which can now be inserted by - typing <">. - - * Completion support for options of some LaTeX packages was added. - - * Already in version 11.81 the way to activate AUCTeX changed - substantially. This should now be done with '(load "auctex.el" nil - t t)' instead of the former '(require 'tex-site)'. Related to this - change 'tex-mik.el' does not load 'tex-site.el' anymore. That - means if you used only '(require 'tex-mik)' in order to activate - AUCTeX, you have to add '(load "auctex.el" nil t t)' before the - latter statement. *Note Loading the package::. - - * Handling of verbatim constructs was consolidated across AUCTeX. - This resulted in the font-latex-specific variables - 'font-latex-verb-like-commands', 'font-latex-verbatim-macros', and - 'font-latex-verbatim-environments' being removed and the more - general variables 'LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-delims', - 'LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-braces', and - 'LaTeX-verbatim-environments' being added. - - * The output of a BibTeX run is now checked for warnings and errors, - which are reported in the echo area. - - * The aliases for 'font-latex-title-fontify' were removed. Use - 'font-latex-fontify-sectioning' instead. - - * The problem that Japanese macros where broken across lines was - fixed. - - * Various bug fixes. - -News in 11.81 -------------- - - * 'LaTeX-mark-section' now marks subsections of a given section as - well. The former behavior is available via the prefix argument. - - * preview-latex which was previously available separately became a - subsystem of AUCTeX. There is no documented provision for building - or installing preview-latex separately. It is still possible to - use and install AUCTeX without preview-latex, however. - - * The installation procedures have been overhauled and now also - install startup files as part of the process (those had to be - copied manually previously). You are advised to remove previous - installations of AUCTeX and preview-latex before starting the - installation procedure. A standard installation from an unmodified - tarball no longer requires Makeinfo or Perl. - - Also note that the way AUCTeX is supposed to be activated changed. - Instead of '(require 'tex-site)' you should now use '(load - "auctex.el" nil t t)'. While the former method may still work, the - new method has the advantage that you can deactivate a preactivated - AUCTeX with the statement '(unload-feature 'tex-site)' before any - of its modes have been used. This may be important especially for - site-wide installations. - - * Support for the babel LaTeX package was added. - - * Folding a buffer now ensures that the whole buffer is fontified - before the actual folding is carried out. If this results in - unbearably long execution times, you can fall back to the old - behavior of relying on stealth font locking to do this job in the - background by customizing the variable 'TeX-fold-force-fontify'. - - * Folded content now reveals part of its original text in a tooltip - or the echo area when hovering with the mouse pointer over it. - - * The language-specific insertion of quotation marks was generalized. - The variables 'LaTeX-german-open-quote', - 'LaTeX-german-close-quote', 'LaTeX-german-quote-after-quote', - 'LaTeX-italian-open-quote', 'LaTeX-italian-close-quote', and - 'LaTeX-italian-quote-after-quote' are now obsolete. If you are not - satisfied with the default settings, you should customize - 'TeX-quote-language-alist' instead. - - * Similar to language-specific quote insertion, AUCTeX now helps you - with hyphens in different languages as well. *Note European::, for - details. - - * Fill problems in Japanese text introduced in AUCTeX 11.55 were - fixed. AUCTeX tries not to break lines between 1-byte and 2-byte - chars. These features will work in Chinese text, too. - - * The scaling factor of the fontification of sectioning commands can - now be customized using the variable - 'font-latex-fontify-sectioning'. This variable was previously - called 'font-latex-title-fontify'; In this release we provide an - alias but this will disappear in one of the the next releases. The - faces for the sectioning commands are now called - 'font-latex-sectioning-N-face' (N=0...5) instead of - 'font-latex-title-N-face' (N=1...4). Analogously the names of the - variables holding the related keyword lists were changed from - 'font-latex-title-N-keywords' to - 'font-latex-sectioning-N-keywords'. *Note Font Locking::, for - details. Make sure to adjust your customizations. - - * Titles in beamer slides marked by the "\frametitle" command are - know displayed with the new face 'font-latex-slide-title-face'. - You can add macros to be highlighted with this face to - 'font-latex-match-slide-title-keywords'. - - * Of course a lot of bugs have been fixed. - -News in 11.55 -------------- - - * A bug was fixed which lead to the insertion of trailing whitespace - during filling. In particular extra spaces were added to sentence - endings at the end of lines. You can make this whitespace visible - by setting the variable 'show-trailing-whitespace' to 't'. If you - want to delete all trailing whitespace in a buffer, type 'M-x - delete-trailing-whitespace <RET>'. - - * A bug was fixed which lead to a '*Compile-Log*' buffer popping up - when the first LaTeX file was loaded in an Emacs session. - - * On some systems the presence of an outdated Emacspeak package lead - to the error message 'File mode specification error: (error - "Variable binding depth exceeds max-specpdl-size")'. Precautions - were added which prevent this error from happening. But - nevertheless, it is advised to upgrade or uninstall the outdated - Emacspeak package. - - * The value of 'TeX-macro-global' is not determined during - configuration anymore but at load time of AUCTeX. Consequently the - associated configuration option '--with-tex-input-dirs' was - removed. - - * Support for the LaTeX Japanese classes 'jsarticle' and 'jsbook' was - added. - -News in 11.54 -------------- - - * The parser (used e.g. for 'TeX-auto-generate-global') was extended - to recognize keywords common in LaTeX packages and classes, like - "\DeclareRobustCommand" or "\RequirePackage". Additionally a bug - was fixed which led to duplicate entries in AUCTeX style files. - - * Folding can now be done for paragraphs and regions besides single - constructs and the whole buffer. With the new 'TeX-fold-dwim' - command content can both be hidden and shown with a single key - binding. In course of these changes new key bindings for unfolding - commands where introduced. The old bindings are still present but - will be phased out in future releases. - - * Info files of the manual now have a .info extension. - - * There is an experimental tool bar support now. It is not activated - by default. If you want to use it, add - (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook 'LaTeX-install-toolbar) - to your init file. - - * The manual now contains a new chapter "Quick Start". It explains - the main features and how to use them, and should be enough for a - new user to start using AUCTeX. - - * A new section "Font Locking" was added to the manual which explains - syntax highlighting in AUCTeX and its customization. Together with - the sections related to folding and outlining, the section is part - of the new chapter "Display". - - * Keywords for syntax highlighting of LaTeX constructs to be typeset - in bold, italic or typewriter fonts may now be customized. Besides - the built-in classes, new keyword classes may be added by - customizing the variable 'font-latex-user-keyword-classes'. The - customization options can be found in the customization group - 'font-latex-keywords'. - - * Verbatim content is now displayed with the 'fixed-pitch' face. - (GNU Emacs only) - - * Syntax highlighting should not spill out of verbatim content - anymore. (GNU Emacs only) - - * Verbatim commands like '\verb|...|' will not be broken anymore - during filling. - - * You can customize the completion for graphic files with - 'LaTeX-includegraphics-read-file'. - - * Support for the LaTeX packages 'url', 'listings', 'jurabib' and - 'csquotes' was added with regard to command completion and syntax - highlighting. - - * Performance of fontification and filling was improved. - - * Insertion of nodes in Texinfo mode now supports completion of - existing node names. - - * Setting the variable 'LaTeX-float' to 'nil' now means that you will - not be prompted for the float position of figures and tables. You - can get the old behaviour of 'nil' by setting the variable to '""', - i.e. an empty string. See also *note Floats::. - - * The XEmacs-specific bug concerning 'overlays-at' was fixed. - - * Lots of bug fixes. - -News in 11.53 -------------- - - * The LaTeX math menu can include Unicode characters if your Emacs - built supports it. See the variable 'LaTeX-math-menu-unicode', - *note Mathematics::. - - * Bug fixes for XEmacs. - - * Completion for graphic files in the TeX search path has been added. - - * 'start' is used for the viewer for MiKTeX and fpTeX. - - * The variable 'TeX-fold-preserve-comments' can now be customized to - deactivate folding in comments. - -News in 11.52 -------------- - - * Installation and menus under XEmacs work again (maybe for the first - time). - - * Fontification of subscripts and superscripts is now disabled when - the fontification engine is not able to support it properly. - - * Bug fixes in the build process. - -News in 11.51 -------------- - - * PDFTeX and Source Special support did not work with ConTeXt, this - has been fixed. Similar for Source Special support under Windows. - - * Omega support has been added. - - * Bug fixes in the build process. - - * 'TeX-fold' now supports folding of environments in Texinfo mode. - -News in 11.50 -------------- - - * The use of source specials when processing or viewing the document - can now be controlled with the new 'TeX-source-specials' minor mode - which can be toggled via an entry in the Command menu or the key - binding 'C-c C-t C-s'. If you have customized the variable - 'TeX-command-list', you have to re-initialize it for this to work. - This means to open a customization buffer for the variable by - typing 'M-x customize-variable <RET> TeX-command-list <RET>', - selecting "Erase Customization" and do your customization again - with the new default. - - * The content of the command menu now depends on the mode (plain TeX, - LaTeX, ConTeXt etc.). Any former customization of the variable - 'TeX-command-list' has to be erased. Otherwise the command menu - and the customization will not work correctly. - - * Support for hiding and auto-revealing macros, e.g. footnotes or - citations, and environments in a buffer was added, *note Folding::. - - * You can now control if indentation is done upon typing <RET> by - customizing the variable 'TeX-newline-function', *note Indenting::. - - * Limited support for 'doc.sty' and 'ltxdoc.cls' ('dtx' files) was - added. The new docTeX mode provides functionality for editing - documentation parts. This includes formatting (indenting and - filling), adding and completion of macros and environments while - staying in comments as well as syntax highlighting. (Please note - that the mode is not finished yet. For example syntax highlighting - does not work yet in XEmacs.) - - * For macro completion in docTeX mode the AUCTeX style files - 'doc.el', 'ltxdoc.el' and 'ltx-base.el' were included. The latter - provides general support for low-level LaTeX macros and may be used - with LaTeX class and style files as well. It is currently not - loaded automatically for those files. - - * Support for ConTeXt with a separate ConTeXt mode is now included. - Macro definitions for completion are available in Dutch and - English. - - * The filling and indentation code was overhauled and is now able to - format commented parts of the source syntactically correct. Newly - available functionality and customization options are explained in - the manual. - - * Filling and indentation in XEmacs with preview-latex and activated - previews lead to the insertion of whitespace before multi-line - previews. AUCTeX now contains facilities to prevent this problem. - - * If 'TeX-master' is set to 't', AUCTeX will now query for a master - file only when a new file is opened. Existing files will be left - alone. The new function 'TeX-master-file-ask' (bound to 'C-c _' is - provided for adding the variable manually. - - * Sectioning commands are now shown in a larger font on display - devices which support such fontification. The variable - 'font-latex-title-fontify' can be customized to restore the old - appearance, i.e. the usage of a different color instead of a change - in size. - - * Support for 'alphanum.sty', 'beamer.cls', 'booktabs.sty', - 'captcont.sty', 'emp.sty', 'paralist.sty', 'subfigure.sty' and - 'units.sty'/'nicefrac.sty' was added. Credits go to the authors - mentioned in the respective AUCTeX style files. - - * Inserting graphics with 'C-c <RET> includegraphics <RET>' was - improved. See the variable 'LaTeX-includegraphics-options-alist'. - - * If 'LaTeX-default-position' is 'nil', don't prompt for position - arguments in Tabular-like environments, see *note Tabular-like::. - - * Completion for available packages when using 'C-c <RET> usepackage - <RET>' was improved on systems using the kpathsea library. - - * The commenting functionality was fixed. The separate functions for - commenting and uncommenting were unified in one function for - paragraphs and regions respectively which do both. - - * Syntax highlighting can be customized to fontify quotes delimited - by either >>German<< or <<French>> quotation marks by changing the - variable 'font-latex-quotes'. - - * Certain TeX/LaTeX keywords for functions, references, variables and - warnings will now be fontified specially. You may add your own - keywords by customizing the variables - 'font-latex-match-function-keywords', - 'font-latex-match-reference-keywords', - 'font-latex-match-variable-keywords' and - 'font-latex-match-warning-keywords'. - - * If you include the style files 'german' or 'ngerman' in a document - (directly or via the 'babel' package), you should now customize - 'LaTeX-german-open-quote', 'LaTeX-german-close-quote' and - 'LaTeX-german-quote-after-quote' instead of 'TeX-open-quote', - 'TeX-close-quote' and 'TeX-quote-after-quote' if you want to - influence the type of quote insertion. - - * Upon viewing an output file, the right viewer and command line - options for it are now determined automatically by looking at the - extension of the output file and certain options used in the source - file. The behavior can be adapted or extended respectively by - customizing the variable 'TeX-output-view-style'. - - * You can control whether 'TeX-insert-macro' ('C-c <RET>') ask for - all optional arguments by customizing the variable - 'TeX-insert-macro-default-style', *note Completion::. - - * 'TeX-run-discard' is now able to completely detach a process that - it started. - - * The build process was enhanced and is now based on 'autoconf' - making installing AUCTeX a mostly automatic process. See *note - Installation:: and *note Installation under MS Windows:: for - details. - -News in 11.14 -------------- - - * Many more LaTeX and LaTeX2e commands are supported. Done by - Masayuki Ataka <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp> - -News in 11.12 -------------- - - * Support for the KOMA-Script classes. Contributed by Mark Trettin - <Mark.Trettin@gmx.de>. - -News in 11.11 -------------- - - * Support for 'prosper.sty', see <http://prosper.sourceforge.net/>. - Contributed by Phillip Lord <p.lord@russet.org.uk>. - -News in 11.10 -------------- - - * 'comment-region' now inserts %% by default. Suggested by "Davide - G. M. Salvetti" <salve@debian.org>>. - -News in 11.06 -------------- - - * You can now switch between using the 'font-latex' (all emacsen), - the 'tex-font' (Emacs 21 only) or no special package for font - locking. Customize 'TeX-install-font-lock' for this. - -News in 11.04 -------------- - - * Now use -t landscape by default when landscape option appears. - Suggested by Erik Frisk <frisk@isy.liu.se>. - -News in 11.03 -------------- - - * Use 'tex-fptex.el' for fpTeX support. Contributed by Fabrice - Popineau <Fabrice.Popineau@supelec.fr>. - -News in 11.02 -------------- - - * New user option 'LaTeX-top-caption-list' specifies environments - where the caption should go at top. Contributed by - <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp> (Masayuki Ataka). - - * Allow explicit dimensions in 'graphicx.sty'. Contributed by - <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp> (Masayuki Ataka). - - * Limited support for 'verbatim.sty'. Contributed by - <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp> (Masayuki Ataka). - - * Better support for amsmath items. Patch by - <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp> (Masayuki Ataka). - - * More accurate error parsing. Added by David Kastrup - <David.Kastrup@t-online.de>. - -News in 11.01 -------------- - - * Bug fixes. - -Older versions --------------- - -See the file 'history.texi' for older changes. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Development, Next: FAQ, Prev: Changes, Up: Appendices - -A.3 Future Development -====================== - -The following sections describe future development of AUCTeX. Besides -mid-term goals, bug reports and requests we cannot fix or honor right -away are being gathered here. If you have some time for Emacs Lisp -hacking, you are encouraged to try to provide a solution to one of the -following problems. If you don't know Lisp, you may help us to improve -the documentation. It might be a good idea to discuss proposed changes -on the mailing list of AUCTeX first. - -* Menu: - -* Mid-term Goals:: -* Wishlist:: -* Bugs:: - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Mid-term Goals, Next: Wishlist, Up: Development - -A.3.1 Mid-term Goals --------------------- - - * Integration of preview-latex into AUCTeX - - As of AUCTeX 11.81 preview-latex is a part of AUCTeX in the sense - that the installation routines were merged and preview-latex is - being packaged with AUCTeX. - - Further integration will happen at the backend. This involves - folding of error parsing and task management of both packages which - will ease development efforts and avoid redundant work. - - * Error help catalogs - - Currently, the help for errors is more or less hardwired into - 'latex.el'. For supporting error help in other languages, it would - be sensible to instead arrange error messages in language-specific - files, make a common info file from all such catalogs in a given - language and look the error texts up in an appropriate index. The - user would then specify a preference list of languages, and the - errors would be looked up in the catalogs in sequence until they - were identified. - - * Combining 'docTeX' with RefTeX - - Macro cross references should also be usable for document - navigation using RefTeX. - - * Fix remove-style feature - - Currently 'TeX-remove-style' implementation isn't good. It is - common practice that major mode functions directly add macros and - environments via 'TeX-add-symbols' and 'LaTeX-add-environments', - but those macros and environments are lost once 'TeX-remove-style' - runs. It is necessary to run major mode function, by e.g. - 'normal-mode', again to recover them, but that makes no point in - running 'TeX-remove-style' itself because major mode function kills - all buffer-local variables. - - As of AUCTeX 12.3, 'TeX-remove-style' is no longer used by any - other codes. - - * Document 'LaTeX-insert-into-commments', - 'TeX-translate-location-hook', and usage of ConTeXt mode. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Wishlist, Next: Bugs, Prev: Mid-term Goals, Up: Development - -A.3.2 Wishlist --------------- - - * Simplify tool bar implementation. The library 'toolbar-x.el' was - developed as an abstraction layer to absorb difference between - XEmacs and GNU Emacs. Now that XEmacs is no longer supported, the - library, together with 'tex-bar.el' as a whole, can be much - simplified (or even unified). - - * Documentation lookup for macros - - A parser could gather information about which macros are defined in - which LaTeX packages and store the information in a hashtable which - can be used in a backend for 'TeX-doc' in order to open the - matching documentation for a given macro. The information could - also be used to insert an appropriate '\usepackage' statement if - the user tries to insert a macro for which the respective package - has not been requested yet. - - * Improvements to error reporting - - Fringe indicators for errors in the main text would be nice. - - * A math entry grid - - A separate frame with a table of math character graphics to click - on in order to insert the respective sequence into the buffer (cf. - the "grid" of 'x-symbol'). - - * Crossreferencing support - - It would be nice if you could index process your favorite - collection of '.dtx' files (such as the LaTeX source), just call a - command on arbitrary control sequence, and get either the DVI - viewer opened right at the definition of that macro (using Source - Specials), or the source code of the '.dtx' file. - - * Better plain TeX support - - For starters, 'LaTeX-math-mode' is not very LaTeX-specific in the - first place, and similar holds for indentation and formatting. - - * Page count when compiling should (optionally) go to modeline of the - window where the compilation command was invoked, instead of the - output window. Suggested by Karsten Tinnefeld - <tinnefeld@irb.informatik.uni-dortmund.de>. - - * Command to insert a macrodefinition in the preamble, without moving - point from the current location. Suggested by "Jeffrey C. Ely" - <ely@nwu.edu>. - - * A database of all commands defined in all stylefiles. When a - command or environment gets entered that is provided in one of the - styles, insert the appropriate '\usepackage' in the preamble. - - * A way to add and overwrite math mode entries in style files, and to - decide where they should be. Suggested by Remo Badii - <Remo.Badii@psi.ch>. - - * Create template for (first) line of tabular environment. - - * I think prompting for the master is the intended behaviour. It - corresponds to a 'shared' value for 'TeX-master'. - - There should probably be a 'none' value which wouldn't query for - the master, but instead disable all features that relies on - 'TeX-master'. - - This default value for 'TeX-master' could then be controled with - mapping based on the extension. - - * Use index files (when available) to speed up 'C-c C-m include - <RET>'. - - * Option not to calculate very slow completions like for 'C-c C-m - include <RET>'. - - * Font menu should be created from 'TeX-font-list'. - - * Installation procedure written purely in emacs lisp. - - * Included PostScript files should also be counted as part of the - document. - - * A nice hierarchical by-topic organization of all officially - documented LaTeX macros, available from the menu bar. - - * 'TeX-command-default' should be set from the master file, if not - set locally. Suggested by Peter Whaite <peta@cim.mcgill.ca>. - - * Make AUCTeX work with 'crypt++'. Suggested by Chris Moore - <Chris.Moore@src.bae.co.uk>. - - * Make AUCTeX work with 'longlines'. This would also apply to - preview-latex, though it might make sense to unify error processing - before attempting this. - - * The 'Spell' command should apply to all files in a document. Maybe - it could try to restrict to files that have been modified since - last spell check? Suggested by Ravinder Bhumbla - <rbhumbla@ucsd.edu>. - - * Make <.> check for abbreviations and sentences ending with capital - letters. - - * Use Emacs 19 minibuffer history to choose between previewers, and - other stuff. Suggested by John Interrante - <interran@uluru.Stanford.EDU>. - - * Documentation of variables that can be set in a style hook. - - We need a list of what can safely be done in an ordinary style - hook. You can not set a variable that AUCTeX depends on, unless - AUCTeX knows that it has to run the style hooks first. - - Here is the start of such a list. - - 'LaTeX-add-environments' - - 'TeX-add-symbols' - - 'LaTeX-add-labels' - - 'LaTeX-add-bibliographies' - - 'LaTeX-largest-level' - - * Outline should be (better) supported in TeX mode. - - At least, support headers, trailers, as well as - 'TeX-outline-extra'. - - * 'TeX-header-start' and 'TeX-trailer-end'. - - We might want these, just for fun (and outlines) - - * Plain TeX and LaTeX specific header and trailer expressions. - - We should have a way to globally specify the default value of the - header and trailer regexps. - - * Get closer to original 'TeX-mode' keybindings. - - A third initialization file ('tex-mode.el') containing an emulator - of the standard 'TeX-mode' would help convince some people to - change to AUCTeX. - - * Use markers in 'TeX-error-list' to remember buffer positions in - order to be more robust with regard to line numbers and changed - files. - - * Finish the Texinfo mode. For one thing, many Texinfo mode commands - do not accept braces around their arguments. - - * Hook up the letter environment with 'bbdb.el'. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Bugs, Prev: Wishlist, Up: Development - -A.3.3 Bugs ----------- - - * The style hooks automatically generated by parsing files for - 'example.dtx', 'example.sty', 'example.drv' and 'example.bib' all - clash. Bad. Clash with hand-written style hooks should be removed - by dialect discrimination -- to be checked. - - * 'C-c `' should always stay in the current window, also when it - finds a new file. - - * Do not overwrite emacs warnings about existing auto-save files when - loading a new file. - - * Maybe the regexp for matching a TeX symbol during parsing should be - '"\\\\\\([a-zA-Z]+\\|.\\)"' -- - <thiemann@informatik.uni-tuebingen.de> Peter Thiemann. - - * AUCTeX should not parse verbatim environments. - - * Make '`' check for math context in 'LaTeX-math-mode'. and simply - self insert if not in a math context. - - * Make 'TeX-insert-dollar' more robust. Currently it can be fooled - by '\mbox''es and escaped double dollar for example. - - * Correct indentation for tabbing, table, and math environments. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: FAQ, Next: Texinfo mode, Prev: Development, Up: Appendices - -A.4 Frequently Asked Questions -============================== - - 1. Something is not working correctly. What should I do? - - Well, you might have guessed it, the first place to look is in the - available documentation packaged with AUCTeX. This could be the - release notes (in the 'RELEASE' file) or the news section of the - manual in case you are experiencing problems after an upgrade, the - 'INSTALL' file in case you are having problems with the - installation, the section about bugs in the manual in case you - encountered a bug or the relevant sections in the manual for other - related problems. - - If this did not help, you can send a bug report to the AUCTeX bug - reporting list by using the command 'M-x TeX-submit-bug-report - <RET>'. But before you do this, you can try to get more - information about the problem at hand which might also help you - locate the cause of the error yourself. - - First, you can try to generate a so-called backtrace which shows - the functions involved in a program error. In order to do this, - start Emacs with the command line 'emacs --debug-init' and/or put - the line - - (setq debug-on-error t) - - as the first line into your init file. After Emacs has started, - you can load a file which triggers the error and a new window - should pop up showing the backtrace. If you get such a backtrace, - please include it in the bug report. - - Second, you can try to figure out if something in your personal or - site configuration triggers the error by starting Emacs without - such customizations. You can do this by invoking Emacs with the - following command line, depending on the installation scheme of - AUCTeX and your OS: - * If you installed AUCTeX from ELPA, use 'emacs -q -no-site-file - --eval "(progn (setq package-load-list '((auctex t))) - (package-initialize))"'. The '--eval' option activates only - AUCTeX among all installed EPLA packages. - * If you installed AUCTeX via traditional 'configure'-'make' - scheme, use 'emacs -q -no-site-file -l auctex'. The '-l' - option loads 'auctex.el' which you normally do in your init - file. - * In both above cases, use 'runemacs' instead of 'emacs' on - windows. - - After you have started Emacs like this, you can load the file - triggering the error. If everything is working now, you know that - you have to search either in the site configuration file or your - personal init file for statements related to the problem. - - 2. What versions of Emacs are supported? - - AUCTeX was tested with GNU Emacs 25.1. Older versions may work but - are unsupported. - - 3. What should I do when './configure' does not find programs like - 'latex'? - - This is problem often encountered on Windows. Make sure that the - 'PATH' environment variable includes the directories containing the - relevant programs, as described in *note (auctex)Installation under - MS Windows::. - - 4. Why doesn't the completion, style file, or multifile stuff work? - - It must be enabled first, insert this in your init file: - - (setq-default TeX-master nil) - (setq TeX-parse-self t) - (setq TeX-auto-save t) - - Read also the chapters about parsing and multifile documents in the - manual. *Note Parsing Files:: and *note Multifile::. - - 5. Why doesn't 'TeX-save-document' work? - - 'TeX-check-path' has to contain "'./'" somewhere. - - 6. Why is the information in 'foo.tex' forgotten when I save - 'foo.bib'? - - For various reasons, AUCTeX ignores the extension when it stores - information about a file, so you should use unique base names for - your files. E.g. rename 'foo.bib' to 'foob.bib'. - - 7. Why doesn't AUCTeX signal when processing a document is done? - - If the message in the minibuffer stays "Type 'C-c C-l' to display - results of compilation.", you probably have a misconfiguration in - your init file ('.emacs', 'init.el' or similar). To track this - down either search in the '*Messages*' buffer for an error message - or put '(setq debug-on-error t)' as the first line into your init - file, restart Emacs and open a LaTeX file. Emacs will complain - loudly by opening a debugging buffer as soon as an error occurs. - The information in the debugging buffer can help you find the cause - of the error in your init file. - - 8. Why does 'TeX-next-error' ('C-c `') fail? - - If 'TeX-file-line-error' is set to nil (not the default), these - sort of failures might be related to the the fact that when writing - the log file, TeX puts information related to a file, including - error messages, between a pair of parentheses. In this scenario - AUCTeX determines the file where the error happened by parsing the - log file and counting the parentheses. This can fail when there - are other, unbalanced parentheses present. - - Activating so-called 'file:line:error' messages for the log file - usually solves this issue, as these kind of messages are are easier - to parse; however, they may lack some details. Activation can be - done either in the configuration of your TeX system (consult its - manual to see where this is) or by simply keeping the variable - 'TeX-file-line-error' to the default value of non-nil. - - 9. What does 'AUC' stand for? - - AUCTeX came into being at Aalborg University in Denmark. Back then - the Danish name of the university was Aalborg Universitetscenter; - 'AUC' for short. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Texinfo mode, Prev: FAQ, Up: Appendices - -A.5 Features specific to AUCTeX's Texinfo major mode -==================================================== - -AUCTeX includes a major mode for editting Texinfo files. This major -mode is not the same mode as the native Texinfo mode (*note -(texinfo)Texinfo Mode::) of Emacs, although they have the same name. -However, AUCTeX still relies on a number of functions from the native -Texinfo mode. - - The following text describes which functionality is offered by AUCTeX -and which by the native Texinfo mode. This should enable you to decide -when to consult the AUCTeX manual and when the manual of the native -mode. And in case you are a seasoned user of the native mode, the -information should help you to swiftly get to know the AUCTeX-specific -commands. - -* Menu: - -* Exploiting:: How AUCTeX and the native mode work together -* Superseding:: Where the native mode is superseded -* Mapping:: Where key bindings are mapped to the native mode -* Unbinding:: Which native mode key bindings are missing - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Exploiting, Next: Superseding, Up: Texinfo mode - -A.5.1 How AUCTeX and the native mode work together --------------------------------------------------- - -In a nutshell the split between AUCTeX Texinfo mode, and native Texinfo -mode is as follows: - - * Most of the editing (environment creation, commenting, font command - insertions) and/or processing commands (e.g. compiling or printing) - which are available in other AUCTeX modes are also handled by - AUCTeX in Texinfo mode. - - * Texinfo-related features (e.g. info node linkage or menu creation) - rely on the commands provided by the native Texinfo mode. AUCTeX - provides the key bindings to reach these functions, keeping the - same keys as in native Texinfo whenever possible, or similar ones - otherwise. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Superseding, Next: Mapping, Prev: Exploiting, Up: Texinfo mode - -A.5.2 Where the native mode is superseded ------------------------------------------ - -This section is directed to users of the native Texinfo mode switching -to AUCTeX. It follows the summary of the native mode (*note -(texinfo)Texinfo Mode Summary::) and lists which of its commands are no -longer of use. - -Insert commands - In the native Texinfo mode, frequently used Texinfo commands can be - inserted with key bindings of the form 'C-c C-c K' where K differs - for each Texinfo command; 'c' inserts '@code', 'd' inserts '@dfn', - 'k' '@kbd', etc. - - In AUCTeX commands are inserted with the key binding 'C-c C-m' - instead which prompts for the macro to be inserted. For font - selection commands (like '@b', '@i', or '@emph') and a few related - ones (like '@var', '@key' or '@code') there are bindings which - insert the respective macros directly. They have the form 'C-c C-f - K' or 'C-c C-f C-K' and call the function 'TeX-font'. Type 'C-c - C-f <RET>' to get a list of supported commands. - - Note that the prefix argument is not handled the same way by - AUCTeX. Note also that the node insertion command from the native - mode ('texinfo-insert-@node') can still accessed from the Texinfo - menu in AUCTeX. - -Insert braces - In AUCTeX braces can be inserted with the same key binding as in - the native Texinfo mode: 'C-c {'. But AUCTeX uses its own function - for the feature: 'TeX-insert-braces'. - -Insert environments - The native Texinfo mode does not insert full environments. - Instead, it provides the function 'texinfo-insert-@end' (mapped to - 'C-c C-c e') for closing an open environment with a matching '@end' - statement. - - In AUCTeX you can insert full environments, i.e. both the opening - and closing statements, with the function 'Texinfo-environment' - (mapped to 'C-c C-e'). - -Format info files with makeinfo and TeX - In the native Texinfo mode there are various functions and bindings - to format a region or the whole buffer for info or to typeset the - respective text. For example, there is 'makeinfo-buffer' (mapped - to 'C-c C-m C-b') which runs 'makeinfo' on the buffer or there is - 'texinfo-tex-buffer' (mapped to 'C-c C-t C-b') which runs TeX on - the buffer in order to produce a DVI file. - - In AUCTeX different commands for formatting or typesetting can be - invoked through the function 'TeX-command-master' (mapped to 'C-c - C-c'). After typing 'C-c C-c', you can select the desired command, - e.g 'Makeinfo' or 'TeX', through a prompt in the mini buffer. Note - that you can make, say 'Makeinfo', the default by adding this - statement in your init file: - - (add-hook 'Texinfo-mode-hook - (lambda () (setq TeX-command-default "Makeinfo"))) - - Note also that 'C-c C-c Makeinfo <RET>' is not completely - functionally equivalent to 'makeinfo-buffer' as the latter will - display the resulting info file in Emacs, showing the node - corresponding to the position in the source file, just after a - successful compilation. This is why, while using AUCTeX, invoking - 'makeinfo-buffer' might still be more convenient. - - Note also that in the case of a multifile document, 'C-c C-c' in - AUCTeX will work on the whole document (provided that the file - variable 'TeX-master' is set correctly), while 'makeinfo-buffer' in - the native mode will process only the current buffer, provided at - the '@setfilename' statement is provided. - -Produce indexes and print - The native Texinfo mode provides the binding 'C-c C-t C-i' - ('texinfo-texindex') for producing an index and the bindings 'C-c - C-t C-p' ('texinfo-tex-print') and 'C-c C-t C-q' - ('tex-show-print-queue') for printing and showing the printer - queue. These are superseded by the respective commands available - through 'C-c C-c' ('TeX-command-master') in AUCTeX: 'Texindex', - 'Print', and 'Queue'. - -Kill jobs - The command 'C-c C-t C-k' ('tex-kill-job') in the native mode is - superseded by 'C-c C-k' ('TeX-kill-job') in AUCTeX. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Mapping, Next: Unbinding, Prev: Superseding, Up: Texinfo mode - -A.5.3 Where key bindings are mapped to the native mode ------------------------------------------------------- - -This node follows the native Texinfo mode summary (*note -(texinfo)Texinfo Mode Summary::) and lists only those commands to which -AUCTeX provides a keybinding. - - Basically all commands of the native mode related to producing menus -and interlinking nodes are mapped to same or similar keys in AUCTeX, -while a few insertion commands are mapped to AUCTeX-like keys. - -'@item' insertion - The binding 'C-c C-c i' for the insertion of '@item' in the native - mode is mapped to 'M-<RET>' or 'C-c C-j' in AUCTeX, similar to - other AUCTeX modes. - -'@end' insertion - The binding 'C-c C-c e' for closing a '@FOO' command by a - corresponding '@end FOO' statement in the native mode is mapped to - 'C-c ]' in AUCTeX, similar to other AUCTeX modes. - -Move out of balanced braces - The binding 'C-c }' ('up-list') is available both in the native - mode and in AUCTeX. (This is because the command is not - implemented in either mode but a native Emacs command.) However, - in AUCTeX, you cannot use 'C-c ]' for this, as it is used for - '@end' insertion. - -Update pointers - The bindings 'C-c C-u C-n' ('texinfo-update-node') and 'C-c C-u - C-e' ('texinfo-every-node-update') from the native mode are - available in AUCTeX as well. - -Update menus - The bindings 'C-c C-u m' ('texinfo-master-menu'), 'C-c C-u C-m' - ('texinfo-make-menu'), and 'C-c C-u C-a' - ('texinfo-all-menus-update') from the native mode are available in - AUCTeX as well. The command 'texinfo-start-menu-description', - bound to 'C-c C-c C-d' in the native mode, is bound to 'C-c C-u - C-d' in AUCTeX instead. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Unbinding, Prev: Mapping, Up: Texinfo mode - -A.5.4 Which native mode key bindings are missing ------------------------------------------------- - -The following commands from the native commands might still be useful -when working with AUCTeX, however, they are not accessible with a key -binding any longer. - -'@node' insertion - The node insertion command, mapped to 'C-c C-c n' in the native - mode, is not mapped to any key in AUCTeX. You can still access it - through the Texinfo menu, though. Another alternative is to use - the 'C-c C-m' binding for macro insertion in AUCTeX. - -Show the section structure - The command 'texinfo-show-structure' ('C-c C-s') from the native - mode does not have a key binding in AUCTeX. The binding is used by - AUCTeX for sectioning. - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Indices, Prev: Appendices, Up: Top - -Indices -******* - -* Menu: - -* Key Index:: -* Function Index:: -* Variable Index:: -* Concept Index:: - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Key Index, Next: Function Index, Up: Indices - -Key Index -========= - - -* Menu: - -* ": Quotes. (line 15) -* $: Quotes. (line 61) -* (: Quotes. (line 154) -* [: Quotes. (line 154) -* ^: Mathematics. (line 64) -* _: Mathematics. (line 64) -* {: Quotes. (line 154) -* C-c %: Commenting. (line 23) -* C-c *: Marking (LaTeX). (line 7) -* C-c * <1>: Marking (Texinfo). (line 7) -* C-c .: Marking (LaTeX). (line 16) -* C-c . <1>: Marking (Texinfo). (line 25) -* C-c ;: Commenting. (line 15) -* C-c ?: Documentation. (line 7) -* C-c C-a: Starting a Command. (line 59) -* C-c C-b: Starting a Command. (line 35) -* C-c C-c: Starting a Command. (line 13) -* C-c C-d: Multifile. (line 99) -* C-c C-e: Environments. (line 23) -* C-c C-f: Font Specifiers. (line 55) -* C-c C-f C-b: Editing Facilities. (line 72) -* C-c C-f C-b <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 16) -* C-c C-f C-c: Editing Facilities. (line 93) -* C-c C-f C-c <1>: Editing Facilities. (line 96) -* C-c C-f C-c <2>: Font Specifiers. (line 40) -* C-c C-f C-c <3>: Font Specifiers. (line 52) -* C-c C-f C-e: Editing Facilities. (line 78) -* C-c C-f C-e <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 25) -* C-c C-f C-f: Editing Facilities. (line 87) -* C-c C-f C-f <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 34) -* C-c C-f C-i: Editing Facilities. (line 75) -* C-c C-f C-i <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 22) -* C-c C-f C-l: Font Specifiers. (line 43) -* C-c C-f C-m: Font Specifiers. (line 19) -* C-c C-f C-n: Font Specifiers. (line 49) -* C-c C-f C-r: Editing Facilities. (line 84) -* C-c C-f C-r <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 31) -* C-c C-f C-s: Editing Facilities. (line 81) -* C-c C-f C-s <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 28) -* C-c C-f C-t: Editing Facilities. (line 90) -* C-c C-f C-t <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 37) -* C-c C-f C-w: Font Specifiers. (line 46) -* C-c C-f g: Japanese. (line 113) -* C-c C-f m: Japanese. (line 117) -* C-c C-k: Control. (line 10) -* C-c C-l: Control. (line 14) -* C-c C-m: Completion. (line 69) -* C-c C-n: Parsing Files. (line 45) -* C-c C-o b: Folding. (line 121) -* C-c C-o C-b: Folding. (line 43) -* C-c C-o C-c: Folding. (line 118) -* C-c C-o C-e: Folding. (line 102) -* C-c C-o C-f: Folding. (line 31) -* C-c C-o C-m: Folding. (line 93) -* C-c C-o C-o: Folding. (line 140) -* C-c C-o C-p: Folding. (line 89) -* C-c C-o C-r: Folding. (line 86) -* C-c C-o i: Folding. (line 133) -* C-c C-o p: Folding. (line 129) -* C-c C-o r: Folding. (line 125) -* C-c C-q C-e: Filling. (line 90) -* C-c C-q C-p: Filling. (line 84) -* C-c C-q C-r: Filling. (line 99) -* C-c C-q C-s: Filling. (line 95) -* C-c C-r: Starting a Command. (line 19) -* C-c C-s: Sectioning. (line 22) -* C-c C-t C-b: Ignoring warnings. (line 10) -* C-c C-t C-i: Processing Facilities. - (line 53) -* C-c C-t C-i <1>: Processor Options. (line 30) -* C-c C-t C-o: Processing Facilities. - (line 59) -* C-c C-t C-p: Processing Facilities. - (line 50) -* C-c C-t C-p <1>: Processor Options. (line 16) -* C-c C-t C-r: Starting a Command. (line 85) -* C-c C-t C-s: Processing Facilities. - (line 56) -* C-c C-t C-s <1>: Processor Options. (line 37) -* C-c C-t C-w: Ignoring warnings. (line 15) -* C-c C-t C-x: Ignoring warnings. (line 39) -* C-c C-v: Starting Viewers. (line 12) -* C-c C-z: Starting a Command. (line 42) -* C-c <LFD>: Itemize-like. (line 10) -* C-c <LFD> <1>: Tabular-like. (line 33) -* C-c ]: Environments. (line 102) -* C-c ^: Control. (line 18) -* C-c _: Multifile. (line 71) -* C-c `: Debugging. (line 12) -* C-c {: Quotes. (line 122) -* C-c ~: Mathematics. (line 12) -* C-j: Indenting. (line 78) -* C-M-a: Environments. (line 107) -* C-M-e: Environments. (line 114) -* C-M-h: Marking (Texinfo). (line 34) -* C-x n e: Narrowing. (line 17) -* C-x n g: Narrowing. (line 14) -* <LFD>: Indenting. (line 78) -* M-g p: Debugging. (line 27) -* M-q: Filling. (line 87) -* M-<TAB>: Completion. (line 24) -* <TAB>: Indenting. (line 74) - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Function Index, Next: Variable Index, Prev: Key Index, Up: Indices - -Function Index -============== - - -* Menu: - -* align-current: Indenting. (line 58) -* ams-tex-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* auto-fill-mode: Filling. (line 6) -* context-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* doctex-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* indent-region: Indenting. (line 29) -* japanese-latex-mode: Japanese. (line 6) -* japanese-plain-tex-mode: Japanese. (line 6) -* LaTeX-add-bibliographies: Adding Other. (line 13) -* LaTeX-add-environments: Adding Environments. (line 66) -* LaTeX-add-labels: Adding Other. (line 16) -* LaTeX-arg-author: Adding Macros. (line 244) -* LaTeX-arg-usepackage: Adding Macros. (line 200) -* LaTeX-CLASSNAME-class-options: Adding Other. (line 107) -* LaTeX-close-environment: Environments. (line 101) -* LaTeX-command-section: Starting a Command. (line 41) -* LaTeX-declare-expert-environments: Adding Environments. (line 128) -* LaTeX-env-args: Adding Environments. (line 109) -* LaTeX-env-array: Adding Environments. (line 81) -* LaTeX-env-bib: Adding Environments. (line 103) -* LaTeX-env-contents: Adding Environments. (line 106) -* LaTeX-env-figure: Adding Environments. (line 77) -* LaTeX-env-item: Adding Environments. (line 74) -* LaTeX-env-label: Adding Environments. (line 85) -* LaTeX-env-list: Adding Environments. (line 88) -* LaTeX-env-minipage: Adding Environments. (line 92) -* LaTeX-env-picture: Adding Environments. (line 100) -* LaTeX-env-tabular*: Adding Environments. (line 96) -* LaTeX-environment: Environments. (line 22) -* LaTeX-fill-environment: Filling. (line 79) -* LaTeX-fill-environment <1>: Filling. (line 90) -* LaTeX-fill-paragraph: Filling. (line 84) -* LaTeX-fill-region: Filling. (line 99) -* LaTeX-fill-section: Filling. (line 95) -* LaTeX-find-matching-begin: Environments. (line 106) -* LaTeX-find-matching-end: Environments. (line 113) -* LaTeX-indent-line: Indenting. (line 74) -* LaTeX-insert-environment: Adding Environments. (line 69) -* LaTeX-insert-item: Itemize-like. (line 9) -* LaTeX-insert-item <1>: Tabular-like. (line 32) -* LaTeX-mark-environment: Marking (LaTeX). (line 15) -* LaTeX-mark-section: Marking (LaTeX). (line 6) -* LaTeX-match-class-option: Adding Other. (line 55) -* LaTeX-math-mode: Mathematics. (line 11) -* latex-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* LaTeX-narrow-to-environment: Narrowing. (line 16) -* LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options: Adding Other. (line 82) -* LaTeX-provided-class-options-member: Adding Other. (line 51) -* LaTeX-provided-package-options-member: Adding Other. (line 37) -* LaTeX-section: Sectioning. (line 21) -* LaTeX-section-heading: Sectioning. (line 69) -* LaTeX-section-label: Sectioning. (line 83) -* LaTeX-section-section: Sectioning. (line 77) -* LaTeX-section-title: Sectioning. (line 72) -* LaTeX-section-toc: Sectioning. (line 75) -* plain-tex-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* TeX--completion-at-point: Completion. (line 51) -* TeX-add-style-hook: Simple Style. (line 34) -* TeX-add-symbols: Adding Macros. (line 24) -* TeX-arg-bibliography: Adding Macros. (line 210) -* TeX-arg-bibstyle: Adding Macros. (line 206) -* TeX-arg-cite: Adding Macros. (line 136) -* TeX-arg-conditional: Adding Macros. (line 86) -* TeX-arg-coordinate: Adding Macros. (line 241) -* TeX-arg-corner: Adding Macros. (line 214) -* TeX-arg-counter: Adding Macros. (line 141) -* TeX-arg-date: Adding Macros. (line 122) -* TeX-arg-define-cite: Adding Macros. (line 182) -* TeX-arg-define-counter: Adding Macros. (line 185) -* TeX-arg-define-environment: Adding Macros. (line 178) -* TeX-arg-define-label: Adding Macros. (line 166) -* TeX-arg-define-length: Adding Macros. (line 170) -* TeX-arg-define-macro: Adding Macros. (line 174) -* TeX-arg-define-savebox: Adding Macros. (line 188) -* TeX-arg-document: Adding Macros. (line 191) -* TeX-arg-environment: Adding Macros. (line 133) -* TeX-arg-eval: Adding Macros. (line 97) -* TeX-arg-file: Adding Macros. (line 147) -* TeX-arg-file-name: Adding Macros. (line 151) -* TeX-arg-file-name-sans-extension: Adding Macros. (line 155) -* TeX-arg-free: Adding Macros. (line 94) -* TeX-arg-hook: Adding Macros. (line 251) -* TeX-arg-index: Adding Macros. (line 113) -* TeX-arg-index-tag: Adding Macros. (line 109) -* TeX-arg-input-file: Adding Macros. (line 159) -* TeX-arg-key-val: Adding Macros. (line 257) -* TeX-arg-label: Adding Macros. (line 100) -* TeX-arg-length: Adding Macros. (line 116) -* TeX-arg-literal: Adding Macros. (line 90) -* TeX-arg-lr: Adding Macros. (line 217) -* TeX-arg-macro: Adding Macros. (line 119) -* TeX-arg-pagestyle: Adding Macros. (line 223) -* TeX-arg-pair: Adding Macros. (line 234) -* TeX-arg-ref: Adding Macros. (line 104) -* TeX-arg-savebox: Adding Macros. (line 144) -* TeX-arg-size: Adding Macros. (line 238) -* TeX-arg-tb: Adding Macros. (line 220) -* TeX-arg-verb: Adding Macros. (line 226) -* TeX-arg-verb-delim-or-brace: Adding Macros. (line 229) -* TeX-arg-version: Adding Macros. (line 129) -* TeX-auto-generate: Automatic Private. (line 23) -* TeX-clean: Cleaning. (line 6) -* TeX-command-buffer: Starting a Command. (line 34) -* TeX-command-master: Starting a Command. (line 12) -* TeX-command-region: Starting a Command. (line 18) -* TeX-command-run-all: Starting a Command. (line 58) -* TeX-comment-or-uncomment-paragraph: Commenting. (line 22) -* TeX-comment-or-uncomment-region: Commenting. (line 14) -* TeX-complete-symbol: Completion. (line 23) -* TeX-declare-expert-macros: Adding Macros. (line 272) -* TeX-documentation-texdoc: Documentation. (line 6) -* TeX-electric-macro: Completion. (line 107) -* TeX-error-overview: Error overview. (line 10) -* TeX-fold-buffer: Folding. (line 42) -* TeX-fold-clearout-buffer: Folding. (line 120) -* TeX-fold-clearout-item: Folding. (line 132) -* TeX-fold-clearout-paragraph: Folding. (line 128) -* TeX-fold-clearout-region: Folding. (line 124) -* TeX-fold-comment: Folding. (line 117) -* TeX-fold-dwim: Folding. (line 139) -* TeX-fold-env: Folding. (line 101) -* TeX-fold-macro: Folding. (line 92) -* TeX-fold-math: Folding. (line 108) -* TeX-fold-mode: Folding. (line 31) -* TeX-fold-paragraph: Folding. (line 88) -* TeX-fold-region: Folding. (line 85) -* TeX-font: Font Specifiers. (line 54) -* TeX-home-buffer: Control. (line 17) -* TeX-insert-braces: Quotes. (line 121) -* TeX-insert-dollar: Quotes. (line 60) -* TeX-insert-macro: Completion. (line 68) -* TeX-insert-quote: Quotes. (line 14) -* TeX-interactive-mode: Processor Options. (line 29) -* TeX-ispell-skip-setcar: Selecting a Command. (line 147) -* TeX-ispell-skip-setcdr: Selecting a Command. (line 147) -* TeX-ispell-tex-arg-end: Selecting a Command. (line 167) -* TeX-kill-job: Control. (line 9) -* TeX-master-file-ask: Multifile. (line 70) -* TeX-narrow-to-group: Narrowing. (line 13) -* TeX-next-error: Debugging. (line 11) -* TeX-normal-mode: Parsing Files. (line 44) -* TeX-PDF-mode: Processor Options. (line 15) -* TeX-pin-region: Starting a Command. (line 84) -* TeX-previous-error: Debugging. (line 26) -* TeX-read-hook: Adding Macros. (line 248) -* TeX-read-key-val: Adding Macros. (line 254) -* TeX-recenter-output-buffer: Control. (line 13) -* TeX-revert-document-buffer: Modes and Hooks. (line 39) -* TeX-save-document: Multifile. (line 98) -* TeX-source-correlate-mode: Processor Options. (line 36) -* TeX-source-correlate-mode <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 12) -* TeX-toggle-debug-bad-boxes: Ignoring warnings. (line 9) -* TeX-toggle-debug-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 14) -* TeX-toggle-suppress-ignored-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 38) -* TeX-view: Starting Viewers. (line 11) -* TeX-view <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 42) -* TeX-view-mouse: I/O Correlation. (line 48) -* Texinfo-mark-environment: Marking (Texinfo). (line 24) -* Texinfo-mark-node: Marking (Texinfo). (line 33) -* Texinfo-mark-section: Marking (Texinfo). (line 6) -* texinfo-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* turn-on-auto-fill: Filling. (line 6) - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Variable Index, Next: Concept Index, Prev: Function Index, Up: Indices - -Variable Index -============== - - -* Menu: - -* AmS-TeX-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* AmSTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* AmSTeX-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* ConTeXt-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* ConTeXt-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* ConTeXt-engine: Processor Options. (line 121) -* ConTeXt-Mark-version: Processor Options. (line 200) -* ConTeXt-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* ConTeXt-Omega-engine: Processor Options. (line 121) -* docTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* docTeX-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* docTeX-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* fill-column: Filling. (line 6) -* font-latex-deactivated-keyword-classes: Fontification of macros. - (line 162) -* font-latex-fontify-script: Fontification of math. - (line 28) -* font-latex-fontify-script-max-level: Fontification of math. - (line 42) -* font-latex-fontify-sectioning: Fontification of macros. - (line 95) -* font-latex-match-bold-command-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 137) -* font-latex-match-bold-declaration-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 137) -* font-latex-match-function-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 60) -* font-latex-match-italic-command-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 137) -* font-latex-match-italic-declaration-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 137) -* font-latex-match-math-command-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 137) -* font-latex-match-math-command-keywords <1>: Fontification of math. - (line 6) -* font-latex-match-reference-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 60) -* font-latex-match-sectioning-0-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 107) -* font-latex-match-sectioning-1-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 107) -* font-latex-match-sectioning-2-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 107) -* font-latex-match-sectioning-3-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 107) -* font-latex-match-sectioning-4-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 107) -* font-latex-match-sectioning-5-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 107) -* font-latex-match-slide-title-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 114) -* font-latex-match-textual-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 60) -* font-latex-match-type-command-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 137) -* font-latex-match-type-declaration-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 137) -* font-latex-match-variable-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 60) -* font-latex-match-warning-keywords: Fontification of macros. - (line 60) -* font-latex-math-environments: Fontification of math. - (line 6) -* font-latex-quotes: Fontification of quotes. - (line 15) -* font-latex-script-char-face: Fontification of math. - (line 63) -* font-latex-script-display: Fontification of math. - (line 66) -* font-latex-sectioning-0-face: Fontification of macros. - (line 96) -* font-latex-sectioning-1-face: Fontification of macros. - (line 96) -* font-latex-sectioning-2-face: Fontification of macros. - (line 96) -* font-latex-sectioning-3-face: Fontification of macros. - (line 96) -* font-latex-sectioning-4-face: Fontification of macros. - (line 96) -* font-latex-sectioning-5-face: Fontification of macros. - (line 96) -* font-latex-slide-title-face: Fontification of macros. - (line 114) -* font-latex-subscript-face: Fontification of math. - (line 42) -* font-latex-superscript-face: Fontification of math. - (line 42) -* font-latex-user-keyword-classes: Fontification of macros. - (line 194) -* japanese-LaTeX-default-style: Japanese. (line 75) -* japanese-TeX-engine-default: Japanese. (line 36) -* japanese-TeX-mode: Japanese. (line 6) -* japanese-TeX-use-kanji-opt-flag: Japanese. (line 87) -* LaTeX-amsmath-label: Equations. (line 15) -* LaTeX-auto-class-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 106) -* LaTeX-auto-counter-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 112) -* LaTeX-auto-index-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 103) -* LaTeX-auto-label-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 100) -* LaTeX-auto-length-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 115) -* LaTeX-auto-minimal-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 97) -* LaTeX-auto-pagestyle-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 109) -* LaTeX-auto-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 121) -* LaTeX-auto-savebox-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 118) -* LaTeX-babel-hyphen: European. (line 168) -* LaTeX-babel-hyphen-after-hyphen: European. (line 176) -* LaTeX-babel-hyphen-language-alist: European. (line 155) -* LaTeX-begin-regexp: Indenting. (line 119) -* LaTeX-biblatex-use-Biber: Selecting a Command. (line 52) -* LaTeX-CLASSNAME-class-options: Adding Other. (line 104) -* LaTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* LaTeX-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* LaTeX-command: Processor Options. (line 121) -* LaTeX-csquotes-close-quote: Quotes. (line 43) -* LaTeX-csquotes-open-quote: Quotes. (line 43) -* LaTeX-csquotes-quote-after-quote: Quotes. (line 43) -* LaTeX-default-author: Adding Macros. (line 245) -* LaTeX-default-document-environment: Environments. (line 61) -* LaTeX-default-environment: Environments. (line 56) -* LaTeX-default-format: Tabular-like. (line 10) -* LaTeX-default-options: Adding Macros. (line 192) -* LaTeX-default-position: Tabular-like. (line 16) -* LaTeX-default-style: Adding Macros. (line 192) -* LaTeX-default-width: Tabular-like. (line 13) -* LaTeX-done-mark: Sectioning. (line 62) -* LaTeX-electric-left-right-brace: Quotes. (line 157) -* LaTeX-enable-toolbar: Processing. (line 11) -* LaTeX-end-regexp: Indenting. (line 119) -* LaTeX-eqnarray-label: Equations. (line 12) -* LaTeX-equation-label: Equations. (line 9) -* LaTeX-figure-label: Floats. (line 32) -* LaTeX-figure-label <1>: Floats. (line 42) -* LaTeX-fill-break-at-separators: Filling. (line 101) -* LaTeX-fill-break-before-code-comments: Filling. (line 111) -* LaTeX-fill-excluded-macros: Filling. (line 121) -* LaTeX-float: Floats. (line 14) -* LaTeX-float <1>: Floats. (line 39) -* LaTeX-fold-env-spec-list: Folding. (line 197) -* LaTeX-fold-macro-spec-list: Folding. (line 197) -* LaTeX-fold-math-spec-list: Folding. (line 197) -* LaTeX-font-list: Font Specifiers. (line 69) -* LaTeX-indent-environment-check: Indenting. (line 51) -* LaTeX-indent-environment-list: Indenting. (line 37) -* LaTeX-indent-environment-list <1>: Indenting. (line 48) -* LaTeX-indent-environment-list <2>: Indenting. (line 86) -* LaTeX-indent-level: Indenting. (line 19) -* LaTeX-indent-level <1>: Indenting. (line 91) -* LaTeX-item-indent: Indenting. (line 19) -* LaTeX-item-indent <1>: Indenting. (line 95) -* LaTeX-item-regexp: Indenting. (line 19) -* LaTeX-label-alist: Environments. (line 38) -* LaTeX-level: Sectioning. (line 53) -* LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix: Mathematics. (line 26) -* LaTeX-math-default: Mathematics. (line 6) -* LaTeX-math-list: Mathematics. (line 36) -* LaTeX-math-menu-unicode: Mathematics. (line 56) -* LaTeX-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* LaTeX-name: Sectioning. (line 56) -* LaTeX-Omega-command: Processor Options. (line 121) -* LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options: Adding Other. (line 69) -* LaTeX-paragraph-commands: Filling. (line 54) -* LaTeX-provided-class-options: Adding Other. (line 44) -* LaTeX-provided-package-options: Adding Other. (line 26) -* LaTeX-section-hook: Sectioning. (line 40) -* LaTeX-section-hook <1>: Sectioning. (line 48) -* LaTeX-section-label: Sectioning. (line 42) -* LaTeX-section-label <1>: Sectioning. (line 101) -* LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length: Floats. (line 27) -* LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length <1>: Floats. (line 51) -* LaTeX-style-list: Adding Macros. (line 192) -* LaTeX-syntactic-comments: Indenting. (line 68) -* LaTeX-syntactic-comments <1>: Indenting. (line 103) -* LaTeX-table-label: Floats. (line 32) -* LaTeX-table-label <1>: Floats. (line 45) -* LaTeX-title: Sectioning. (line 58) -* LaTeX-toc: Sectioning. (line 60) -* LaTeX-top-caption-list: Floats. (line 20) -* LaTeX-top-caption-list <1>: Floats. (line 48) -* LaTeX-verbatim-environments: Verbatim content. (line 10) -* LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-braces: Verbatim content. (line 10) -* LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-delims: Verbatim content. (line 10) -* outline-regexp: Marking (Texinfo). (line 10) -* plain-TeX-auto-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 124) -* plain-TeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* plain-TeX-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* plain-TeX-enable-toolbar: Processing. (line 11) -* plain-TeX-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* TeX-after-compilation-finished-functions: Modes and Hooks. (line 30) -* TeX-after-compilation-finished-functions <1>: Modes and Hooks. - (line 40) -* TeX-arg-cite-note-p: Adding Macros. (line 137) -* TeX-arg-input-file-search: Adding Macros. (line 160) -* TeX-arg-input-file-search <1>: Adding Macros. (line 192) -* TeX-arg-input-file-search <2>: Adding Macros. (line 201) -* TeX-arg-item-label-p: Itemize-like. (line 15) -* TeX-arg-right-insert-p: Quotes. (line 150) -* TeX-auto-cleanup-hook: Hacking the Parser. (line 100) -* TeX-auto-empty-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 94) -* TeX-auto-full-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 127) -* TeX-auto-global: Automatic Global. (line 24) -* TeX-auto-local: Automatic Local. (line 21) -* TeX-auto-parse-length: Parsing Files. (line 88) -* TeX-auto-prepare-hook: Hacking the Parser. (line 97) -* TeX-auto-private: Automatic Private. (line 19) -* TeX-auto-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 85) -* TeX-auto-regexp-list <1>: Hacking the Parser. (line 78) -* TeX-auto-save: Parsing Files. (line 41) -* TeX-auto-untabify: Parsing Files. (line 58) -* TeX-bar-LaTeX-button-alist: Processing. (line 11) -* TeX-bar-LaTeX-buttons: Processing. (line 11) -* TeX-bar-TeX-all-button-alists: Processing. (line 11) -* TeX-bar-TeX-buttons: Processing. (line 11) -* TeX-brace-indent-level: Indenting. (line 99) -* TeX-check-engine: Processor Options. (line 164) -* TeX-check-path: Selecting a Command. (line 68) -* TeX-check-TeX: Processor Options. (line 149) -* TeX-check-TeX-command-not-found: Processor Options. (line 150) -* TeX-clean-confirm: Cleaning. (line 30) -* TeX-close-quote: Quotes. (line 25) -* TeX-command: Processor Options. (line 121) -* TeX-command <1>: Processor Options. (line 150) -* TeX-command-default: Selecting a Command. (line 43) -* TeX-command-extra-options: Processor Options. (line 172) -* TeX-command-list: Starting a Command. (line 16) -* TeX-command-list <1>: Starting a Command. (line 32) -* TeX-command-list <2>: Selecting a Command. (line 14) -* TeX-complete-expert-commands: Environments. (line 78) -* TeX-complete-expert-commands <1>: Completion. (line 142) -* TeX-complete-list: Completion. (line 26) -* TeX-date-format: Adding Macros. (line 123) -* TeX-debug-bad-boxes: Ignoring warnings. (line 10) -* TeX-debug-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 15) -* TeX-default-macro: Completion. (line 76) -* TeX-default-mode: Japanese. (line 6) -* TeX-default-mode <1>: Japanese. (line 67) -* TeX-dialect: Simple Style. (line 82) -* TeX-display-help: Debugging. (line 47) -* TeX-DVI-via-PDFTeX: Processor Options. (line 22) -* TeX-electric-escape: Completion. (line 97) -* TeX-electric-math: Quotes. (line 72) -* TeX-electric-sub-and-superscript: Mathematics. (line 70) -* TeX-engine: Processor Options. (line 104) -* TeX-engine <1>: Japanese. (line 6) -* TeX-engine-alist: Processor Options. (line 121) -* TeX-engine-alist <1>: Processor Options. (line 132) -* TeX-engine-alist <2>: Japanese. (line 6) -* TeX-engine-alist-builtin: Processor Options. (line 121) -* TeX-error-overview-frame-parameters: Error overview. (line 43) -* TeX-error-overview-open-after-TeX-run: Error overview. (line 25) -* TeX-error-overview-setup: Error overview. (line 34) -* TeX-expand-list: Selecting a Command. (line 14) -* TeX-file-line-error: Processor Options. (line 193) -* TeX-file-recurse: Automatic. (line 44) -* TeX-fold-auto: Folding. (line 70) -* TeX-fold-command-prefix: Folding. (line 145) -* TeX-fold-env-spec-list: Folding. (line 187) -* TeX-fold-force-fontify: Folding. (line 62) -* TeX-fold-help-echo-max-length: Folding. (line 224) -* TeX-fold-macro-spec-list: Folding. (line 154) -* TeX-fold-math-spec-list: Folding. (line 194) -* TeX-fold-preserve-comments: Folding. (line 75) -* TeX-fold-type-list: Folding. (line 57) -* TeX-fold-unfold-around-mark: Folding. (line 81) -* TeX-fold-unspec-env-display-string: Folding. (line 207) -* TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string: Folding. (line 203) -* TeX-fold-unspec-use-name: Folding. (line 211) -* TeX-font-list: Font Specifiers. (line 60) -* TeX-header-end: Starting a Command. (line 32) -* TeX-header-end <1>: Starting a Command. (line 69) -* TeX-ignore-file: Automatic. (line 52) -* TeX-ignore-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 25) -* TeX-indent-close-delimiters: Indenting. (line 133) -* TeX-indent-open-delimiters: Indenting. (line 128) -* TeX-insert-braces: Completion. (line 117) -* TeX-insert-braces-alist: Completion. (line 121) -* TeX-insert-macro-default-style: Completion. (line 80) -* TeX-install-font-lock: Font Locking. (line 13) -* TeX-interactive-mode: Processor Options. (line 30) -* TeX-ispell-extend-skip-list: Selecting a Command. (line 83) -* TeX-ispell-verb-delimiters: Selecting a Command. (line 176) -* TeX-japanese-process-input-coding-system: Japanese. (line 95) -* TeX-japanese-process-output-coding-system: Japanese. (line 99) -* TeX-language-bg-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-cz-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-de-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-dk-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-en-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-is-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-it-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-nl-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-pl-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-pt-br-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-pt-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-sk-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-language-sv-hook: European. (line 51) -* TeX-macro-global: Customizing. (line 19) -* TeX-macro-global <1>: Automatic Global. (line 16) -* TeX-macro-private: Automatic Private. (line 12) -* TeX-master: Starting a Command. (line 16) -* TeX-master <1>: Starting a Command. (line 32) -* TeX-master <2>: Multifile. (line 39) -* TeX-math-input-method-off-regexp: Mathematics. (line 76) -* TeX-newline-function: Indenting. (line 29) -* TeX-newline-function <1>: Indenting. (line 107) -* TeX-Omega-command: Processor Options. (line 121) -* TeX-one-master: Multifile. (line 57) -* TeX-open-quote: Quotes. (line 21) -* TeX-outline-extra: Outline. (line 13) -* TeX-output-dir: Control. (line 25) -* TeX-parse-all-errors: Debugging. (line 35) -* TeX-parse-self: Parsing Files. (line 38) -* TeX-parse-self <1>: Japanese. (line 6) -* TeX-PDF-from-DVI: Processor Options. (line 71) -* TeX-PDF-mode: Processor Options. (line 16) -* TeX-quote-after-quote: Quotes. (line 29) -* TeX-quote-language-alist: European. (line 142) -* TeX-raise-frame-function: I/O Correlation. (line 85) -* TeX-region: Starting a Command. (line 32) -* TeX-region <1>: Starting a Command. (line 65) -* TeX-save-query: Multifile. (line 102) -* TeX-show-compilation: Processor Options. (line 185) -* TeX-source-correlate-map: I/O Correlation. (line 48) -* TeX-source-correlate-method: Processor Options. (line 48) -* TeX-source-correlate-method <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 21) -* TeX-source-correlate-mode: Processor Options. (line 37) -* TeX-source-correlate-start-server: I/O Correlation. (line 57) -* TeX-source-correlate-start-server <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 63) -* TeX-source-correlate-start-server <2>: I/O Correlation. (line 77) -* TeX-style-global: Automatic Global. (line 19) -* TeX-style-local: Automatic Local. (line 16) -* TeX-style-path: Automatic. (line 38) -* TeX-style-private: Automatic Private. (line 28) -* TeX-suppress-ignored-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 39) -* TeX-trailer-start: Starting a Command. (line 32) -* TeX-trailer-start <1>: Starting a Command. (line 74) -* TeX-view-evince-keep-focus: Starting Viewers. (line 92) -* TeX-view-predicate-list: Starting Viewers. (line 56) -* TeX-view-program-list: Starting Viewers. (line 65) -* TeX-view-program-selection: Starting Viewers. (line 36) -* Texinfo-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* Texinfo-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7) -* Texinfo-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22) -* texinfo-section-list: Marking (Texinfo). (line 10) -* texmathp-tex-commands: Fontification of math. - (line 6) -* texmathp-tex-commands-default: Fontification of math. - (line 6) - - -File: auctex.info, Node: Concept Index, Prev: Variable Index, Up: Indices - -Concept Index -============= - - -* Menu: - -* .emacs: Loading the package. (line 6) -* \begin: Environments. (line 6) -* \chapter: Editing Facilities. (line 24) -* \chapter <1>: Sectioning. (line 6) -* \cite, completion of: Completion. (line 154) -* \emph: Editing Facilities. (line 78) -* \emph <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 25) -* \end: Environments. (line 6) -* \include: Multifile. (line 6) -* \input: Multifile. (line 6) -* \item: Itemize-like. (line 6) -* \label: Editing Facilities. (line 24) -* \label <1>: Sectioning. (line 6) -* \label, completion: Completion. (line 154) -* \mathgt: Japanese. (line 113) -* \mathmc: Japanese. (line 117) -* \ref, completion: Completion. (line 154) -* \section: Editing Facilities. (line 24) -* \section <1>: Sectioning. (line 6) -* \subsection: Editing Facilities. (line 24) -* \subsection <1>: Sectioning. (line 6) -* \textbf: Editing Facilities. (line 72) -* \textbf <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 16) -* \textgt: Japanese. (line 113) -* \textit: Editing Facilities. (line 75) -* \textit <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 22) -* \textmc: Japanese. (line 117) -* \textmd: Font Specifiers. (line 19) -* \textnormal: Font Specifiers. (line 49) -* \textrm: Editing Facilities. (line 84) -* \textrm <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 31) -* \textsc: Editing Facilities. (line 93) -* \textsc <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 40) -* \textsf: Editing Facilities. (line 87) -* \textsf <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 34) -* \textsl: Editing Facilities. (line 81) -* \textsl <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 28) -* \textsw: Font Specifiers. (line 46) -* \texttt: Editing Facilities. (line 90) -* \texttt <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 37) -* \textulc: Font Specifiers. (line 43) -* Abbreviations: Mathematics. (line 6) -* Adding a style hook: Simple Style. (line 6) -* Adding bibliographies: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Adding environments: Adding Environments. (line 6) -* Adding labels: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Adding macros: Adding Macros. (line 6) -* Adding other information: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Adding support for completion of package/class options: Adding Other. - (line 6) -* Adding to PATH in Windows: Installation under MS Windows. - (line 42) -* align.el: Indenting. (line 58) -* amsmath: Equations. (line 6) -* amsmath <1>: Tabular-like. (line 6) -* Arguments to TeX macros: Completion. (line 6) -* ASCII pTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* ASCII pTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6) -* auctex.el: Loading the package. (line 10) -* auctex.el <1>: Changes. (line 841) -* auto directories.: Automatic. (line 6) -* auto-fill-mode: Indenting. (line 29) -* Auto-Reveal: Folding. (line 6) -* Automatic: Automatic. (line 6) -* Automatic Customization: Automatic. (line 6) -* Automatic Parsing: Parsing Files. (line 6) -* Automatic updating style hooks: Automatic Local. (line 6) -* Bad boxes: Debugging. (line 6) -* Biber: Selecting a Command. (line 47) -* biblatex: Selecting a Command. (line 47) -* Bibliographies, adding: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Bibliography: Commands. (line 6) -* bibliography, completion: Completion. (line 154) -* BibTeX: Commands. (line 6) -* BibTeX, completion: Completion. (line 154) -* book.el: Simple Style. (line 6) -* Braces: Quotes. (line 6) -* Brackets: Quotes. (line 6) -* Brazilian Portuguese: European. (line 51) -* Bulgarian: European. (line 51) -* Changing font: Font Specifiers. (line 6) -* Changing the parser: Hacking the Parser. (line 6) -* Chapters: Editing Facilities. (line 24) -* Chapters <1>: Sectioning. (line 6) -* Checking: Checking. (line 6) -* ChinaTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* chktex: Checking. (line 6) -* citations, completion of: Completion. (line 154) -* cite, completion of: Completion. (line 154) -* CJK language: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* CJK-LaTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* Cleaning: Cleaning. (line 6) -* Commands: Commands. (line 6) -* Completion: Completion. (line 6) -* Controlling the output: Control. (line 6) -* Copying: Copying. (line 6) -* Copyright: Copying. (line 6) -* CTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* Current file: Control. (line 6) -* Customization: Customizing. (line 6) -* Customization, personal: Customizing. (line 6) -* Customization, site: Customizing. (line 6) -* Czech: European. (line 51) -* Danish: European. (line 51) -* Debugging: Debugging. (line 6) -* Default command: Commands. (line 6) -* Defining bibliographies in style hooks: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Defining environments in style hooks: Adding Environments. (line 6) -* Defining labels in style hooks: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Defining macros in style hooks: Adding Macros. (line 6) -* Defining other information in style hooks: Adding Other. (line 5) -* Deleting fonts: Editing Facilities. (line 96) -* Deleting fonts <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 52) -* Descriptions: Itemize-like. (line 6) -* Display math mode: Quotes. (line 6) -* Distribution: Copying. (line 6) -* Documentation: Documentation. (line 6) -* Documents: Multifile. (line 6) -* Documents with multiple files: Multifile. (line 6) -* Dollar signs, color bleed with: Known problems. (line 6) -* Dollars: Quotes. (line 6) -* Double quotes: Quotes. (line 6) -* Dutch: European. (line 51) -* English: European. (line 51) -* Enumerates: Itemize-like. (line 6) -* Environments: Environments. (line 6) -* Environments, adding: Adding Environments. (line 6) -* Eqnarray: Equations. (line 6) -* Equation: Equations. (line 6) -* Equations: Equations. (line 6) -* Errors: Debugging. (line 6) -* Europe: European. (line 6) -* European Characters: European. (line 6) -* Examining package/class options: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Example of a style file.: Simple Style. (line 6) -* Expansion: Completion. (line 6) -* External Commands: Commands. (line 6) -* Extracting TeX symbols: Automatic. (line 6) -* Faces: Faces. (line 6) -* FDL, GNU Free Documentation License: GNU Free Documentation License. - (line 6) -* Figure environment: Floats. (line 6) -* Figures: Floats. (line 6) -* Filling: Filling. (line 6) -* Finding errors: Checking. (line 6) -* Finding the current file: Control. (line 6) -* Finding the master file: Control. (line 6) -* Floats: Floats. (line 6) -* Flymake: Checking. (line 6) -* Folding: Folding. (line 6) -* Folding <1>: Outline. (line 6) -* Font Locking: Font Locking. (line 6) -* Font macros: Font Specifiers. (line 6) -* font-latex: Font Locking. (line 6) -* Fonts: Font Specifiers. (line 6) -* Formatting: Indenting. (line 6) -* Formatting <1>: Filling. (line 6) -* Formatting <2>: Commands. (line 6) -* Forward search: I/O Correlation. (line 6) -* Free: Copying. (line 6) -* Free software: Copying. (line 6) -* General Public License: Copying. (line 6) -* Generating symbols: Automatic. (line 6) -* German: European. (line 51) -* Global directories: Automatic Global. (line 6) -* Global macro directory: Automatic Global. (line 6) -* Global style hook directory: Automatic Global. (line 6) -* Global TeX macro directory: Automatic Global. (line 6) -* GPL: Copying. (line 6) -* Header: Commands. (line 6) -* Headers: Outline. (line 6) -* Hide Macros: Folding. (line 6) -* HLaTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* I/O correlation: Processor Options. (line 36) -* I/O correlation <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 6) -* Including: Multifile. (line 6) -* Indentation: Indenting. (line 6) -* Indenting: Indenting. (line 6) -* Indexing: Commands. (line 6) -* init.el: Loading the package. (line 6) -* Initialization: Customizing. (line 6) -* input method: Mathematics. (line 73) -* Inputing: Multifile. (line 6) -* Installation: Build/install and uninstall. - (line 6) -* Internationalization: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* Inverse search: I/O Correlation. (line 6) -* ISO 8859 Latin 1: European. (line 6) -* ISO Character set: European. (line 6) -* iso-cvt.el: European. (line 29) -* ispell: Selecting a Command. (line 74) -* ispell <1>: European. (line 38) -* Italian: European. (line 51) -* Itemize: Itemize-like. (line 6) -* Items: Itemize-like. (line 6) -* Japan: Japanese. (line 6) -* Japanese: Japanese. (line 6) -* jLaTeX: Japanese. (line 6) -* jTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* jTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6) -* Killing a process: Control. (line 6) -* kTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* Label prefix: Sectioning. (line 111) -* Label prefix <1>: Floats. (line 32) -* Labels: Sectioning. (line 111) -* Labels <1>: Floats. (line 32) -* Labels, adding: Adding Other. (line 6) -* labels, completion of: Completion. (line 154) -* lacheck: Checking. (line 6) -* Language Support: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* LaTeX: Commands. (line 6) -* Latin 1: European. (line 5) -* License: Copying. (line 6) -* Literature: Commands. (line 6) -* Local style directory: Automatic Local. (line 6) -* Local style hooks: Automatic Local. (line 6) -* Local style hooks <1>: Automatic Local. (line 6) -* Macro arguments: Completion. (line 6) -* Macro completion: Completion. (line 6) -* Macro expansion: Completion. (line 6) -* macro.el: Hacking the Parser. (line 6) -* macro.tex: Hacking the Parser. (line 6) -* Macros, adding: Adding Macros. (line 6) -* Make: Build/install and uninstall. - (line 6) -* makeindex: Commands. (line 6) -* Making a bibliography: Commands. (line 6) -* Making an index: Commands. (line 6) -* Many Files: Multifile. (line 6) -* Master file: Control. (line 6) -* Master file <1>: Multifile. (line 6) -* Matching dollar signs: Quotes. (line 6) -* Math mode delimiters: Quotes. (line 6) -* Math, fontification of: Fontification of math. - (line 6) -* Math, fontification problems with: Known problems. (line 6) -* Mathematics: Mathematics. (line 6) -* Multifile Documents: Multifile. (line 6) -* Multiple Files: Multifile. (line 6) -* Next error: Debugging. (line 6) -* Nippon: Japanese. (line 6) -* NTT jTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* NTT jTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6) -* Other information, adding: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Outlining: Folding. (line 6) -* Outlining <1>: Outline. (line 6) -* Output: Control. (line 6) -* Overfull boxes: Debugging. (line 6) -* Overview: Outline. (line 6) -* package/class options, Examining: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Parsing errors: Debugging. (line 6) -* Parsing LaTeX errors: Debugging. (line 6) -* Parsing new macros: Hacking the Parser. (line 6) -* Parsing TeX: Parsing Files. (line 6) -* Parsing TeX <1>: Automatic. (line 6) -* Parsing TeX output: Debugging. (line 6) -* PATH in Windows: Installation under MS Windows. - (line 42) -* PDF mode: Processor Options. (line 16) -* PDFSync: Processor Options. (line 36) -* PDFSync <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 6) -* Personal customization: Customizing. (line 6) -* Personal information: Automatic Private. (line 6) -* Personal macro directory: Automatic Private. (line 6) -* Personal TeX macro directory: Automatic Private. (line 6) -* pLaTeX: Japanese. (line 6) -* Polish: European. (line 51) -* Portuguese: European. (line 51) -* Prefix for labels: Sectioning. (line 111) -* Prefix for labels <1>: Floats. (line 32) -* preview-install-styles: Configure. (line 85) -* Previewing: Viewing. (line 6) -* Printing: Commands. (line 6) -* Private directories: Automatic Private. (line 6) -* Private macro directory: Automatic Private. (line 6) -* Private style hook directory: Automatic Private. (line 6) -* Private TeX macro directory: Automatic Private. (line 6) -* Problems: Checking. (line 6) -* Processes: Control. (line 6) -* pTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* pTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6) -* Quotes: Quotes. (line 6) -* Quotes, fontification of: Fontification of quotes. - (line 6) -* Redisplay output: Control. (line 6) -* Refilling: Filling. (line 6) -* Reformatting: Indenting. (line 6) -* Reformatting <1>: Filling. (line 6) -* Region: Commands. (line 6) -* Region file: Commands. (line 6) -* Reindenting: Indenting. (line 6) -* Reveal: Folding. (line 6) -* Right: Copying. (line 6) -* Running BibTeX: Commands. (line 6) -* Running chktex: Checking. (line 6) -* Running commands: Commands. (line 6) -* Running Flymake: Checking. (line 6) -* Running lacheck: Checking. (line 6) -* Running LaTeX: Commands. (line 6) -* Running makeindex: Commands. (line 6) -* Running TeX: Commands. (line 6) -* Sample style file: Simple Style. (line 6) -* Sectioning: Editing Facilities. (line 24) -* Sectioning <1>: Sectioning. (line 6) -* Sectioning commands, fontification of: Fontification of macros. - (line 91) -* Sections: Editing Facilities. (line 24) -* Sections <1>: Sectioning. (line 6) -* Sections <2>: Outline. (line 6) -* Setting the default command: Commands. (line 6) -* Setting the header: Commands. (line 6) -* Setting the trailer: Commands. (line 6) -* Site customization: Customizing. (line 6) -* Site information: Automatic Global. (line 6) -* Site initialization: Customizing. (line 6) -* Site macro directory: Automatic Global. (line 6) -* Site TeX macro directory: Automatic Global. (line 6) -* Slovak: European. (line 51) -* Source specials: Processor Options. (line 36) -* Source specials <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 6) -* Specifying a font: Font Specifiers. (line 6) -* Starting a previewer: Viewing. (line 6) -* Stopping a process: Control. (line 6) -* Style: Checking. (line 6) -* style: Style Files. (line 6) -* Style file: Simple Style. (line 6) -* Style files: Style Files. (line 6) -* Style hook: Simple Style. (line 6) -* Style hooks: Style Files. (line 6) -* subscript: Mathematics. (line 64) -* Subscript, fontification of: Fontification of math. - (line 6) -* superscript: Mathematics. (line 64) -* Superscript, fontification of: Fontification of math. - (line 6) -* support for completion of package/class options, Adding: Adding Other. - (line 6) -* Swedish: European. (line 51) -* Symbols: Mathematics. (line 6) -* SyncTeX: Processor Options. (line 36) -* SyncTeX <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 6) -* Syntax Highlighting: Font Locking. (line 6) -* Tabify: Parsing Files. (line 6) -* Table environment: Floats. (line 6) -* Tables: Floats. (line 6) -* Tabs: Parsing Files. (line 6) -* TeX: Commands. (line 6) -* TeX parsing: Automatic. (line 6) -* tex-jp.el: Japanese. (line 6) -* tex-mik.el: Installation under MS Windows. - (line 252) -* tex-site.el: Loading the package. (line 10) -* tex-site.el <1>: Customizing. (line 6) -* tex-site.el <2>: Changes. (line 841) -* tool bar, toolbar: Processing. (line 11) -* Trailer: Commands. (line 6) -* Underfull boxes: Debugging. (line 6) -* Uninstallation: Build/install and uninstall. - (line 6) -* Untabify: Parsing Files. (line 6) -* Updating style hooks: Automatic Local. (line 6) -* upLaTeX: Japanese. (line 6) -* upTeX: Internationalization. - (line 6) -* upTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6) -* Verbatim, fontification of: Verbatim content. (line 6) -* Viewer predicates: Adding Other. (line 6) -* Viewing: Viewing. (line 6) -* Warranty: Copying. (line 6) -* Writing to a printer: Commands. (line 6) -* X-Symbol: European. (line 32) - - - -Tag Table: -Node: Top917 -Node: Copying7373 -Node: Introduction9318 -Node: Summary9588 -Node: Installation12321 -Node: Prerequisites14294 -Node: Configure16493 -Node: Build/install and uninstall21071 -Node: Loading the package21824 -Node: Advice for package providers23517 -Node: Advice for non-privileged users26322 -Node: Installation under MS Windows31668 -Node: Customizing45290 -Node: Quick Start46875 -Ref: Quick Start-Footnote-148996 -Node: Editing Facilities49090 -Node: Processing Facilities53785 -Node: Editing58514 -Node: Quotes59844 -Node: Font Specifiers68284 -Node: Sectioning70352 -Node: Environments74871 -Node: Equations80024 -Node: Floats80616 -Node: Itemize-like82620 -Node: Tabular-like83342 -Node: Customizing Environments85115 -Node: Mathematics85355 -Node: Completion88791 -Node: Marking95822 -Node: Marking (LaTeX)96446 -Node: Marking (Texinfo)97388 -Node: Commenting98999 -Node: Indenting100324 -Node: Filling108018 -Node: Display113888 -Node: Font Locking116383 -Node: Fontification of macros118462 -Node: Fontification of quotes127978 -Node: Fontification of math129472 -Node: Verbatim content133140 -Node: Faces133914 -Node: Known problems134411 -Node: Folding135408 -Node: Outline146181 -Node: Narrowing147460 -Node: Prettifying148529 -Node: Processing149766 -Node: Commands151094 -Node: Starting a Command151650 -Node: Selecting a Command156666 -Node: Processor Options165785 -Node: Viewing176178 -Node: Starting Viewers176552 -Node: I/O Correlation182202 -Ref: I/O Correlation-Footnote-1187878 -Node: Debugging188128 -Node: Ignoring warnings190746 -Node: Error overview192805 -Node: Checking194713 -Node: Control196329 -Node: Cleaning198438 -Node: Documentation199797 -Node: Customization200512 -Node: Modes and Hooks201005 -Node: Multifile202893 -Node: Parsing Files207625 -Node: Internationalization212614 -Node: European213962 -Node: Japanese221441 -Node: Automatic226505 -Node: Automatic Global228996 -Node: Automatic Private230128 -Node: Automatic Local231464 -Node: Style Files232495 -Node: Simple Style233301 -Node: Adding Macros237022 -Node: Adding Environments246521 -Node: Adding Other251185 -Node: Hacking the Parser255785 -Node: Appendices259774 -Node: Copying this Manual260070 -Node: GNU Free Documentation License260953 -Node: Changes286073 -Node: Development340925 -Node: Mid-term Goals341571 -Node: Wishlist343539 -Node: Bugs349299 -Node: FAQ350379 -Node: Texinfo mode356099 -Node: Exploiting357233 -Node: Superseding358051 -Node: Mapping362282 -Node: Unbinding364117 -Node: Indices364938 -Node: Key Index365101 -Node: Function Index372630 -Node: Variable Index384608 -Node: Concept Index409749 - -End Tag Table - - -Local Variables: -coding: utf-8 -End: |